doc: remove non-existing command riscv set_scratch_ram
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @section Interface Drivers
2371
2372 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2373 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2374 available at run time.
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2377 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2378 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2379 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2382 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2383 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2384 @end deffn
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2387 Displays status of RTCK option.
2388 Optionally sets that option first.
2389 @end deffn
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2393 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2394 This has one driver-specific command:
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2397 Logs some status
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2402 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2403 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2404 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2405 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2406 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2410 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2411 or v2 (USB bulk).
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2428 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2429
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2432 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2433 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2434 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2435 @end itemize
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2439 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2440 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2441 interface string or for user class interface.
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2445 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2446 @end deffn
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2450 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2454 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2458 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2459 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2460
2461 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2462 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2463
2464 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2465 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2466
2467 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2468 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2469 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2470 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2471 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2472 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2473
2474 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2475 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2476 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2477 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2478 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2479
2480 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2481 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2482 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2483 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2484
2485 @itemize @minus
2486 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2487 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2488 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2489 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2491 switching data and direction as necessary
2492 @end itemize
2493
2494 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2495 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2498 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2499 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2500 @example
2501 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2502 @end example
2503 @end deffn
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2506 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2507 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2508 during device selection.
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi serial} serial-number
2512 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2513 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2514 is connected to the host.
2515 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2516 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2517 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2521 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2522 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2526 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2527 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2528 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2529 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2530 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2531 and initially asserted reset signals.
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2535 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2536 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2537 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2538 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2539 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2540 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2541 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2542 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2543 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2544 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2545
2546 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2547 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2548 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2549 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2550 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2551 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2552
2553 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2554 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2555 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2556 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2557 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2558 are always driven by the FTDI.
2559
2560 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2561 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2562 @var{name}.
2563 @end deffn
2564
2565 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2566 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2567 @itemize @minus
2568 @item @option{0}, drive low
2569 @item @option{1}, drive high
2570 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2571 @end itemize
2572 @end deffn
2573
2574 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2575 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2579 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2580
2581 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2582 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2583 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2584 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2585 @itemize @minus
2586 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2587 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2588 @end itemize
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2592 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2593
2594 @end deffn
2595
2596 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2597 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2598 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2599 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2600
2601 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2604 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2605 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2606 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2607 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2608 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2609 @end itemize
2610
2611 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2612 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2613 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2614 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2615 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2616 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2617 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2618 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2619
2620 FT232R
2621 @itemize @minus
2622 @item bit 7 - RI
2623 @item bit 6 - DCD
2624 @item bit 5 - DSR
2625 @item bit 4 - DTR
2626 @item bit 3 - CTS
2627 @item bit 2 - RTS
2628 @item bit 1 - RXD
2629 @item bit 0 - TXD
2630 @end itemize
2631
2632 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2633 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2636 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2637 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r serial_desc} @var{serial}
2641 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2642 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2643 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2644 @end deffn
2645
2646 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2647 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2648 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2649 @end deffn
2650
2651 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2652 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2656 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2660 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2664 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2668 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2672 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2676 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2677 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2678 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2679 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2680 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2681 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2682 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2683 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2684 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2690 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2691 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2692 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2693
2694 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2695 processors which are being simulated.
2696
2697 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2698 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2699 sockets instead of TCP.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2703 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2704 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2708 something like:
2709
2710 @example
2711 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2712 remote_bitbang port 3335
2713 remote_bitbang host foobar
2714 @end example
2715
2716 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2717 named mysocket:
2718
2719 @example
2720 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2721 remote_bitbang port 0
2722 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2723 @end example
2724 @end deffn
2725
2726 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2727 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2728 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2729 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2730
2731 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2732 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2733 default values are used.
2734 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2735 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2736 @example
2737 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2738 @end example
2739 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2740 @example
2741 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2742 @end example
2743 @end deffn
2744
2745 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2746 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2747 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2748 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2749 target board.
2750
2751 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2752 @example
2753 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2754 reset_config srst_only
2755 @end example
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2759 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2760 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2761 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2762 @end deffn
2763
2764 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2765 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2766 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @end deffn
2770
2771 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2772 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2773 This has one driver-specific command:
2774
2775 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2776 Display either the address of the I/O port
2777 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2778 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2779 This is a write-once setting.
2780 @end deffn
2781 @end deffn
2782
2783 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2784 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2785 transports.
2786
2787 @quotation Compatibility Note
2788 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2789 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2790 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2791 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2792 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2793 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2794 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2795 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2796 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2797 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2798 @end quotation
2799
2800 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2801 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2802 states.
2803 @end deffn
2804 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2805 Display free device internal memory.
2806 @end deffn
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2808 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2809 command version.
2810 @end deffn
2811 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2812 Display the device configuration.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2815 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2816 power state.
2817 @end deffn
2818 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2819 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2822 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2823 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2824 IP configuration.
2825 @end deffn
2826 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2827 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2828 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2831 Reset the current configuration.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2834 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2837 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2838 pairs.
2839
2840 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2841 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2842 @example
2843 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2844 @end example
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2847 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2848 pairs.
2849
2850 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2851 @example
2852 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2853 77a90000
2854 @end example
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2857 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2858 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2859 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2860 the serial number instead, if possible.
2861
2862 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2865 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2866 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2867
2868 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2869 @end deffn
2870 @end deffn
2871
2872 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2873 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2874 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2875 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2876 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2877 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2878 configuration script.
2879
2880 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2881 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2882 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2883 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2884 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2885
2886 Known limitations:
2887 @itemize @bullet
2888 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2889 and 2.7 MHz.
2890 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2891 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2892 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2893 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2894 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2895 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2896 communications with the target.
2897 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2898 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2899 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2900 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2901 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2902 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2903 @end itemize
2904
2905 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2906 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2907 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2908 @end deffn
2909
2910 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2911 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2912 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2916 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2917 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2918 target as a side-effect.
2919 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2923 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2924 version, and target voltage.
2925 @end deffn
2926 @end deffn
2927
2928 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2929 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2930 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2931 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2932 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2933
2934 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2935 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2936 This is a write-once setting.
2937 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2938
2939 @itemize @minus
2940 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2941 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2942 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2943 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2944 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2945 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2946 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2947 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2948 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2949 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2950 some versions of
2951 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2952 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2953 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2954 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2955 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2956 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2957 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2958 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2959 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2960 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2961 @end itemize
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2965 Display either the address of the I/O port
2966 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2967 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2968 This is a write-once setting.
2969
2970 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2971 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2972 you may encounter a problem.
2973 @end deffn
2974
2975 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2976 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2977 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2978 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2979 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2980 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2981
2982 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2983 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2984 @quotation Tip
2985 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2986 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2987 @example
2988 > parport toggling_time 1000
2989 > adapter speed 500
2990 @end example
2991 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2992 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2993 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2994 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2995 large set of samples.
2996 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2997 @example
2998 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2999 @end example
3000 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3001 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3002
3003 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3004 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3005 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3006 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3007 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3008 be conservative.
3009 @end quotation
3010 @end deffn
3011
3012 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3013 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3014 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3015 @end deffn
3016
3017 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3018 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3019
3020 @example
3021 adapter driver parport
3022 parport port 0x278
3023 parport cable wiggler
3024 @end example
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3028 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3029 @deffn {Config Command} {presto serial} serial_string
3030 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3031 @end deffn
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3035 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3036 @end deffn
3037
3038 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3039 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3040 @end deffn
3041
3042 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3043 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3044
3045 @quotation Note
3046 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3047 which are not currently documented here.
3048 @end quotation
3049 @end deffn
3050
3051 @anchor{hla_interface}
3052 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3053 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3054 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3055 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3056
3057 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3058 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3059 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3060 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3061 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3062 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3063
3064 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3065 Currently Not Supported.
3066 @end deffn
3067
3068 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3069 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3070 @end deffn
3071
3072 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3073 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3077 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3078 @end deffn
3079
3080 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3081 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3082 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3083
3084 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3085 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3086 ST-LINK server software module}.
3087 @end deffn
3088
3089 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3090 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3091 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3092 @end deffn
3093 @end deffn
3094
3095 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3096 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3097 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3098 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3099 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3100
3101 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3102 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3103 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3104 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3105
3106 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3107 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3108
3109 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3110 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3111 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3112
3113 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3114 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3115 ST-LINK server software module}.
3116
3117 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3118 @end deffn
3119
3120 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3121 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3122 @end deffn
3123
3124 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3125 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3126 @end deffn
3127
3128 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3129 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3130 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3131
3132 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3133 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3134 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3135 the target's supply voltage.
3136 @example
3137 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3138 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3139 @end example
3140 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3141 @example
3142 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3143 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3144 3.24891518738
3145 @end example
3146 @end deffn
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3150 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3151 @end deffn
3152
3153 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3154 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3155 @end deffn
3156
3157 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3158 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3159 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3160 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3161 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3162
3163 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3164 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3165 XDS110 found will be used.
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3169 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3170 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3171 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3172 @end deffn
3173
3174 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3175 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3176 version).
3177 @end deffn
3178 @end deffn
3179
3180 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3181 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3182 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3183 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3184 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3185
3186 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3187
3188 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3189 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3190
3191 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3192 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3193
3194 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3195
3196 @end deffn
3197 @end deffn
3198
3199 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3200 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3201 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3202
3203 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3204 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3205 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3206 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3207 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3208 configuration on exit.
3209
3210 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3211
3212 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3213 pinout.
3214
3215 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3216 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3217 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3218 individually.
3219 @end deffn
3220
3221 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3222 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3223 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3227 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3228 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3229 @end deffn
3230
3231 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3232 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3233 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3234 @end deffn
3235
3236 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3237 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3238 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3239 @end deffn
3240
3241 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3242 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3243 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3244 @end deffn
3245
3246 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3247 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3248 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3249 @end deffn
3250
3251 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3252 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3253 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3254 @end deffn
3255
3256 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3257 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3258 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3259 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3260 @end deffn
3261
3262 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3263 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3264 @end deffn
3265
3266 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3267 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3268 @end deffn
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3271 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3272 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3273 @end deffn
3274
3275 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3276 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3277 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3278 list can be found in the
3279 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282 @end deffn
3283
3284 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3285 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3286 of the one which is most popular.
3287
3288 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3289
3290 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3291 pinout.
3292
3293 @end deffn
3294
3295
3296 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3297 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3298 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3299
3300 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3301 @end deffn
3302
3303
3304 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3305 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3306 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3307
3308 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3309 @end deffn
3310
3311
3312 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3313 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3314 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3315
3316 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3317 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3318 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3319
3320 @itemize @minus
3321 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3322 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3323 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3324 @end itemize
3325 @end deffn
3326
3327 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3328 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3329 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3330 @end deffn
3331 @end deffn
3332
3333
3334 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3335 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3336 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3337 DPI server interface.
3338
3339 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3340 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3341 @end deffn
3342
3343 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3344 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3345 @end deffn
3346 @end deffn
3347
3348
3349 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3350
3351 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3352 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3353
3354 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3355 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3356
3357 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3358 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3359 @example
3360 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3361 @end example
3362 @end deffn
3363
3364 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3365 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3366 @example
3367 buspirate speed normal
3368 @end example
3369 @end deffn
3370
3371 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3372 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3373 @itemize @minus
3374 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3375 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3376 @end itemize
3377 For example:
3378 @example
3379 buspirate mode normal
3380 @end example
3381 @end deffn
3382
3383 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3384 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3385 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3386 For example:
3387 @example
3388 buspirate pullup 0
3389 @end example
3390 @end deffn
3391
3392 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3393 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3394 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3395 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3396 @example
3397 buspirate vreg 0
3398 @end example
3399 @end deffn
3400
3401 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3402 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3403 @end deffn
3404 @example
3405 buspirate led 1
3406 @end example
3407
3408 @end deffn
3409
3410
3411 @section Transport Configuration
3412 @cindex Transport
3413 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3414 and the debug adapter you are using,
3415 several transports may be available to
3416 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3417 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3418 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3419 version of OpenOCD.
3420 @end deffn
3421
3422 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3423 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3424
3425 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3426 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3427 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3428 adapter's driver).
3429
3430 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3431 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3432 supported by the debug adapter.
3433
3434 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3435 transport, if any.
3436 @end deffn
3437
3438 @subsection JTAG Transport
3439 @cindex JTAG
3440 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3441 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3442 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3443 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3444 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3445 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3446
3447 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3448 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3449 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3450 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3451 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3452
3453 @subsection SWD Transport
3454 @cindex SWD
3455 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3456 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3457 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3458 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3459 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3460 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3461 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3462
3463 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3464 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3465 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3466 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3467 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3468
3469 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3470 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3471 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3472 expected to change.
3473 @end deffn
3474 @deffn {Command} {swd wcr trn prescale}
3475 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3476 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3477 No parameters: displays current settings.
3478 @end deffn
3479
3480 @subsection SPI Transport
3481 @cindex SPI
3482 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3483 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3484 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3485 solution for flash programming.
3486
3487 @anchor{swimtransport}
3488 @subsection SWIM Transport
3489 @cindex SWIM
3490 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3491 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3492 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3493 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3494
3495 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3496
3497 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3498
3499 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3500 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3501 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3502 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3503 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3504
3505 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3506 @section JTAG Speed
3507 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3508 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3509 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3510 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3511 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3512 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3513 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3514 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3515 power management software that may be active.
3516
3517 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3518 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3519 target event handler.
3520 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3521 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3522 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3523 sets up those clocks).
3524 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3525 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3526 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3527 in the target config file.
3528 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3529 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3530 config file instead.
3531 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3532 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3533 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3534
3535 @example
3536 jtag_rclk 3000
3537 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3538 @end example
3539
3540 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3541 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3542 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3543 may not be the fastest solution.
3544
3545 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3546 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3547 which support adaptive clocking.
3548
3549 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3550 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3551 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3552 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3553 than the speed specified.
3554
3555 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3556 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3557 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3558 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3559
3560 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3561 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3562 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3563 JTAG clocking after setup.
3564 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3565 If the interface device can not
3566 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3567 @end deffn
3568
3569 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3570 @cindex adaptive clocking
3571 @cindex RTCK
3572 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3573 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3574 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3575 @example
3576 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3577 jtag_rclk 3000
3578 @end example
3579 @end defun
3580
3581 @node Reset Configuration
3582 @chapter Reset Configuration
3583 @cindex Reset Configuration
3584
3585 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3586 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3587 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3588 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3589 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3590 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3591 Please see the various board files for examples.
3592
3593 @quotation Note
3594 To maintainers and integrators:
3595 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3596 Normally the board configuration file
3597 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3598 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3599
3600 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3601 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3602 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3603 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3604 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3605 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3606 @end quotation
3607
3608 @section Types of Reset
3609
3610 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3611 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3612 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3613
3614 @itemize @bullet
3615 @item
3616 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3617 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3618 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3619 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3620 @item
3621 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3622 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3623 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3624 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3625 @item
3626 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3627 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3628 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3629 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3630 @item
3631 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3632 several other types of reset.
3633 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3634 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3635 There may be individual module resets.
3636 @end itemize
3637
3638 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3639 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3640 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3641 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3642 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3643 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3644 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3645 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3646 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3647
3648 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3649 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3650
3651 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3652 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3653 common issues are:
3654
3655 @itemize @bullet
3656
3657 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3658 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3659 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3660 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3661 when either of those signals is not connected.
3662 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3663 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3664 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3665 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3666
3667 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3668 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3669 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3670 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3671
3672 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3673 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3674 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3675 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3676 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3677 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3678 hardware debouncing.
3679 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3680 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3681
3682 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3683 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3684 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3685 to use push/pull output drivers.
3686 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3687 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3688 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3689 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3690
3691 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3692 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3693 issues (not limited to errata).
3694 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3695 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3696 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3697 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3698 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3699 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3700 @end itemize
3701
3702 There can also be other issues.
3703 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3704 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3705 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3706 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3707 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3708 Agreement (NDA).
3709
3710 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3711 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3712 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3713
3714 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3715 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3716
3717 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3718
3719 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3720 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3721 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3722 allowing it to be deasserted.
3723 @end deffn
3724
3725 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3726 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3727 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3728 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3729 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3730 @end deffn
3731
3732 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3733 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3734 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3735 allowing it to be deasserted.
3736 @end deffn
3737
3738 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3739 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3740 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3741 @end deffn
3742
3743 @anchor{reset_config}
3744 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3745 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3746 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3747 configuration scripts.
3748
3749 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3750 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3751 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3752 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3753 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3754 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3755 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3756 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3757
3758 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3759 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3760 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3761 -- may be specified at a time.
3762 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3763 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3764 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3765 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3766 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3767
3768 @itemize
3769 @item
3770 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3771 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3772 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3773 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3774 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3775
3776 @quotation Tip
3777 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3778 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3779 @end quotation
3780
3781 @item
3782 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3783 signal implementations.
3784 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3785 indicating everything behaves normally.
3786 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3787 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3788 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3789 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3790 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3791 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3792 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3793
3794 @item
3795 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3796 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3797 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3798 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3799 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3800 while SRST is asserted.
3801 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3802 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3803
3804 @item
3805 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3806 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3807 is required to use this option.
3808 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3809 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3810 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3811 be asserted before any target connection.
3812 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3813 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3814 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3815 @end itemize
3816
3817 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3818 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3819 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3820 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3821 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3822
3823 @itemize
3824 @item
3825 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3826 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3827 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3828 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3829
3830 @item
3831 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3832 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3833 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3834 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3835 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3836 @end itemize
3837 @end deffn
3838
3839 @section Custom Reset Handling
3840 @cindex events
3841
3842 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3843 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3844 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3845 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3846 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3847 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3848
3849 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3850 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3851 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3852 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3853 want to reset everything at once.
3854
3855 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3856 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3857 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3858 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3859 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3860 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3861 needs special attention.
3862
3863 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3864 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3865 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3866 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3867 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3868 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3869 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3870 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3871 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3872
3873 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3874 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3875 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3876 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3877 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3878
3879 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3880 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3881 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3882 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3883 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3884 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3885 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3886 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3887 or potentially some other value.
3888
3889 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3890 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3891 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3892 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3893 (or their associated targets)
3894 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3895
3896 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3897 they return.
3898 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3899 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3900 @end deffn
3901
3902 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3903 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3904 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3905 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3906 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3907 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3908 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3909 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3910 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3911 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3912 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3913 @end deffn
3914
3915 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3916 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3917 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3918 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3919 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3920 @end deffn
3921
3922
3923 @node TAP Declaration
3924 @chapter TAP Declaration
3925 @cindex TAP declaration
3926 @cindex TAP configuration
3927
3928 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3929 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3930
3931 @itemize @bullet
3932 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3933 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3934 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3935 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3936 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3937 start running that code.
3938 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3939 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3940 and missing connections.
3941 @end itemize
3942
3943 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3944 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3945 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3946 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3947 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3948
3949 @section Scan Chains
3950 @cindex scan chain
3951
3952 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3953 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3954 They also need to be added to
3955 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3956 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3957 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3958 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3959 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3960 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3961 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3962 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3963
3964 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3965 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3966 command, presented in the next chapter.
3967 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3968 debugging targets.)
3969 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3970
3971 @verbatim
3972 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3973 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3974 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3975 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3976 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3977 @end verbatim
3978
3979 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3980 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3981 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3982 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3983 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3984 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3985 until they are told to do so.
3986
3987 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3988 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3989 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3990 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3991
3992 @example
3993 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3994 @end example
3995
3996 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3997 by a given chip.
3998 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3999 and so forth.
4000 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4001 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4002 both inside a single chip and between them.
4003 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4004
4005 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4006 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4007 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4008 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4009 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4010 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4011 includes commands something like this:
4012
4013 @example
4014 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4015 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4016 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4017 @end example
4018
4019 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4020 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4021 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4022
4023 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4024 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4025 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4026 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4027 @example
4028 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4029 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4030 @}
4031 @end example
4032 @end deffn
4033
4034 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4035 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4036 and their status.
4037 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4038 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4039 but systems with a JTAG router can
4040 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4041 @end deffn
4042
4043 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4044 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4045
4046 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4047 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4048
4049 @section TAP Names
4050 @cindex dotted name
4051
4052 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4053 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4054 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4055 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4056 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4057 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4058 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4059 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4060
4061 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4062 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4063 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4064
4065 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4066
4067 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4068 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4069 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4070
4071 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4072 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4073 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4074 overridable.
4075
4076 @cindex TAP naming convention
4077 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4078 and should follow this convention:
4079
4080 @itemize @bullet
4081 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4082 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4083 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4084 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4085 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4086 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4087 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4088 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4089 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4090 with a single TAP;
4091 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4092 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4093 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4094 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4095 @end itemize
4096
4097 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4098
4099 @itemize @bullet
4100 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4101 @*The length in bits of the
4102 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4103 @end itemize
4104
4105 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4106
4107 @itemize @bullet
4108 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4109 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4110 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4111 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4112 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4113 (the TAP is linked in).
4114 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4115 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4116 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4117 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4118 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4119 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4120 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4121 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4122 values that were found but not included in the list.
4123
4124 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4125 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4126 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4127 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4128 hardware to find these values.
4129 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4130 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4131 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4132 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4133 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4134 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4135 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4136 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4137 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4138 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4139 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4140 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4141 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4142 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4143 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4144 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4145 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4146 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4147 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4148 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4149 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4150 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4151 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4152 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4153 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4154 @end itemize
4155 @end deffn
4156
4157 @section Other TAP commands
4158
4159 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4160 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4161 @end deffn
4162
4163 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4164 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4165 At this writing this TAP attribute
4166 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4167 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4168 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4169 See the next section for information about the available events.
4170
4171 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4172 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4173 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4174 @end deffn
4175
4176 @section TAP Events
4177 @cindex events
4178 @cindex TAP events
4179
4180 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4181 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4182 The other applies to debugger targets,
4183 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4184
4185 The TAP events currently defined are:
4186
4187 @itemize @bullet
4188 @item @b{post-reset}
4189 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4190 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4191 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4192 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4193 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4194
4195 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4196 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4197 of any particular target.
4198 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4199 @item @b{setup}
4200 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4201 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4202 @item @b{tap-disable}
4203 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4204 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4205 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4206 @item @b{tap-enable}
4207 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4208 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4209 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4210 @end itemize
4211
4212 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4213 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4214 contents to be accurate), you might:
4215
4216 @example
4217 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4218 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4219 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4220 @}
4221 @end example
4222
4223
4224 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4225 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4226 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4227 @cindex jrc
4228
4229 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4230 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4231 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4232 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4233 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4234
4235 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4236 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4237 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4238 be visible.
4239 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4240 ignores, such as:
4241
4242 @itemize
4243 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4244 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4245 TAPs receive new instructions.
4246 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4247 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4248 @end itemize
4249
4250 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4251 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4252 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4253 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4254
4255 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4256 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4257
4258 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4259 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4260 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4261 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4262 should define TAP event handlers using
4263 code that looks something like this:
4264
4265 @example
4266 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4267 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4268 @}
4269 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4270 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4271 @}
4272 @end example
4273
4274 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4275
4276 @example
4277 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4278 @end example
4279
4280 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4281 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4282 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4283 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4284
4285 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4286 If necessary, disables the tap
4287 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4288 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4289 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4290 and "0" if it is disabled.
4291 @end deffn
4292
4293 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4294 If necessary, enables the tap
4295 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4296 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4297 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4298 and "0" if it is disabled.
4299 @end deffn
4300
4301 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4302 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4303 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4304 and "0" if it is disabled.
4305
4306 @quotation Note
4307 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4308 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4309 @end quotation
4310 @end deffn
4311
4312 @anchor{autoprobing}
4313 @section Autoprobing
4314 @cindex autoprobe
4315 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4316
4317 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4318 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4319 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4320 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4321
4322 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4323 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4324 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4325 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4326 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4327 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4328 right when they come out of reset).
4329
4330 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4331
4332 @example
4333 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4334 reset_config trst_and_srst
4335 jtag_rclk 8
4336 @end example
4337
4338 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4339 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4340
4341 @enumerate
4342 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4343 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4344 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4345 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4346 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4347 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4348 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4349 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4350 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4351 that is discovered.
4352 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4353 register, it will report it.
4354 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4355 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4356 @end enumerate
4357
4358 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4359 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4360 that's a bit more complex:
4361
4362 @example
4363 clock speed 8 kHz
4364 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4365 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4366 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4367 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4368 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4369 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4370 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4371 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4372 @end example
4373
4374 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4375 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4376 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4377 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4378 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4379 and so forth.
4380
4381 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4382 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4383 @cindex DAP declaration
4384
4385 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4386 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4387 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4388 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4389 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4390
4391 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4392
4393 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4394 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4395 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4396 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4397 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4398
4399 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4400
4401 @itemize @bullet
4402 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4403 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4404 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4405 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4406 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4407
4408 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4409 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4410 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4411 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4412 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4413 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4414
4415 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4416 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4417 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4418 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4419 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4420 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4421 @end itemize
4422 @end deffn
4423
4424 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4425 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4426 for TCL scripting.
4427 @end deffn
4428
4429 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4430 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4431 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4432 @end deffn
4433
4434 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4435 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4436 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4437 initialization, too.
4438 @end deffn
4439
4440 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4441
4442 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4443 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4444 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4445 @end deffn
4446
4447 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4448 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4449 @end deffn
4450
4451 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4452 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4453 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4454 or set a new value @var{value}.
4455 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4456 @end deffn
4457
4458 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4459 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4460 @end deffn
4461
4462 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4463 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4464 value @var{value}.
4465
4466 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4467 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4468 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4469
4470 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4471 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4472 @end deffn
4473
4474 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4475 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4476 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4477 @end deffn
4478
4479 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4480 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4481 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4482 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4483 @end deffn
4484
4485 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4486 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4487
4488 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4489 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4490 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4491 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4492 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4493 for details.
4494
4495 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4496 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4497 the pattern:
4498 @example
4499 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4500 @end example
4501
4502 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4503 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4504 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4505 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4506 @example
4507 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4508 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4509 @end example
4510
4511 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4512 @example
4513 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4514 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4515 @end example
4516
4517 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4518 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4519
4520 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4521 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4522 example with a proper dap name:
4523 @example
4524 xxx.dap apcsw default
4525 @end example
4526 @end deffn
4527
4528 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4529 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4530 Disabled by default
4531 @end deffn
4532
4533
4534 @node CPU Configuration
4535 @chapter CPU Configuration
4536 @cindex GDB target
4537
4538 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4539 You can also access these targets without GDB
4540 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4541 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4542 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4543 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4544
4545 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4546 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4547
4548 @section Target List
4549 @cindex target, current
4550 @cindex target, list
4551
4552 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4553 where each member has a name.
4554 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4555 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4556 (plural!) command.
4557 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4558 look like with more than one:
4559 @verbatim
4560 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4561 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4562 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4563 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4564 @end verbatim
4565
4566 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4567 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4568 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4569 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4570 space seen by that current target.
4571 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4572 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4573 are examples; and there are many more.
4574
4575 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4576
4577 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4578 Returns the name of the current target.
4579 @end deffn
4580
4581 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4582 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4583 @example
4584 foreach t [target names] @{
4585 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4586 @}
4587 @end example
4588 @end deffn
4589
4590 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4591 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4592
4593 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4594 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4595 command names are singular.}
4596
4597 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4598 targets in a user friendly form.
4599
4600 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4601 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4602 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4603 @end deffn
4604
4605 @section Target CPU Types
4606 @cindex target type
4607 @cindex CPU type
4608
4609 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4610 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4611 when calling @command{target create}.
4612 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4613 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4614 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4615 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4616 what core-specific commands may be available
4617 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4618 and more.
4619
4620 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4621 since there's a command to list them.
4622
4623 @anchor{targettypes}
4624 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4625 Lists all supported target types.
4626 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4627
4628 @itemize @bullet
4629 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4630 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4631 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4632 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4633 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4634 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4635 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4636 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4637 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4638 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4639 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4640 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4641 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4642 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4643 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4644 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4645 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4646 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4647 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4648 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4649 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4650 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4651 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4652 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4653 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4654 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4655 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4656 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4657 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4658 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4659 support for new CPUs.
4660 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4661 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4662 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4663 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4664 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4665 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4666 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4667 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4668 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4669 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4670 @itemize @minus
4671 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4672 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4673 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4674 @end itemize
4675 And two debug interfaces cores:
4676 @itemize @minus
4677 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4678 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4679 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4680 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4681 @end itemize
4682 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4683 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4684 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4685 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4686 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4687 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4688 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4689 @end itemize
4690 @end deffn
4691
4692 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4693 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4694 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4695 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4696 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4697 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4698 reflect design generations;
4699 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4700 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4701
4702 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4703 @section Target Configuration
4704
4705 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4706 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4707 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4708 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4709 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4710
4711 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4712 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4713 optional parts.
4714 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4715 command, created as part of target creation.
4716
4717 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4718 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4719 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4720 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4721 to be much more board-specific.
4722 The key steps you use might look something like this
4723
4724 @example
4725 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4726 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4727 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4728 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4729 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4730 @end example
4731
4732 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4733 on-chip SRAM.
4734 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4735 writes to target memory;
4736 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4737 GDB memory checksumming;
4738 and more.
4739
4740 @quotation Warning
4741 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4742 inaccessible when application code
4743 (such as an operating system)
4744 enables or disables the MMU.
4745 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4746 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4747 easy access to other addresses needed.
4748 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4749 @end quotation
4750
4751 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4752 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4753 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4754 controllers.
4755 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4756 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4757 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4758
4759 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4760 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4761 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4762 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4763 purposes including additional configuration.
4764
4765 @itemize @bullet
4766 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4767 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4768 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4769 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4770
4771 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4772 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4773 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4774 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4775 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4776 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4777 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4778
4779 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4780 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4781 @end itemize
4782 @end deffn
4783
4784 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4785 The options accepted by this command may also be
4786 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4787 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4788 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4789
4790 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4791 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4792 and changing its endianness.
4793
4794 @itemize @bullet
4795
4796 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4797 used to access this target.
4798
4799 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4800 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4801 create and manage DAP instances.
4802
4803 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4804 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4805
4806 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4807 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4808 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4809 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4810 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4811 same event name assigns only one handler.
4812
4813 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4814 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4815
4816 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4817 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4818 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4819 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4820 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4821 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4822 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4823
4824 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4825 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4826 or virtual address is being used.
4827
4828 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4829 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4830
4831 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4832 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4833 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4834 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4835 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4836
4837 @anchor{rtostype}
4838 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4839 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4840 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4841 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4842 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4843 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4844
4845 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4846 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4847 access the target for debugging.
4848
4849 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4850 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4851 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4852 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4853
4854 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4855 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4856 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4857 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4858 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4859
4860 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4861 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4862 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4863 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4864 command @command{gdb_port}.
4865 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4866
4867 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4868 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4869 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4870 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4871 @end itemize
4872 @end deffn
4873
4874 @section Other $target_name Commands
4875 @cindex object command
4876
4877 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4878 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4879
4880 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4881 Once a button is created a button
4882 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4883 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4884 configure it like this:
4885
4886 @example
4887 # Create
4888 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4889 # Modify
4890 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4891 # Query
4892 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4893 # Report
4894 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4895 @end example
4896
4897 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4898 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4899
4900 @example
4901 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4902 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4903 @end example
4904
4905 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4906
4907 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4908 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4909 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4910 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4911 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4912 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4913 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4914 They are not otherwise documented here.
4915 @end deffn
4916
4917 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4918 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4919 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4920 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4921 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4922 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4923 the target side uses raw memory.
4924
4925 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4926 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4927 The script orientation comes from working with data
4928 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4929 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4930 and neither store nor return those values.
4931
4932 @itemize
4933 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4934 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4935 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4936 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4937 @end itemize
4938 @end deffn
4939
4940 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4941 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4942 @command{$target_name configure}
4943 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4944 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4945 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4946 There are a few special cases:
4947
4948 @itemize @bullet
4949 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4950 event named @var{event_name}.
4951 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4952 two parameters.
4953 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4954 This is a special case because this is set using
4955 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4956 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4957 @end itemize
4958
4959 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4960 all the targets you might use something like this:
4961
4962 @example
4963 foreach name [target names] @{
4964 set y [$name cget -endian]
4965 set z [$name cget -type]
4966 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4967 $x $name $y $z]
4968 @}
4969 @end example
4970 @end deffn
4971
4972 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4973 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4974 Displays the current target state:
4975 @code{debug-running},
4976 @code{halted},
4977 @code{reset},
4978 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4979 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4980 @end deffn
4981
4982 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4983 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4984 currently associated with this target.
4985 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4986 @end deffn
4987
4988 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4989 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4990 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4991 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4992 @end deffn
4993
4994 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4995 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4996 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4997 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4998 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4999 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5000 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5001 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5002 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5003 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5004 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5005 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5006 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5007 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
5008 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
5009 @end deffn
5010
5011 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5012 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5013 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5014 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5015 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5016 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5017 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5018 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5019 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5020 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5021 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5022 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5023 @end deffn
5024
5025 @anchor{targetevents}
5026 @section Target Events
5027 @cindex target events
5028 @cindex events
5029 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5030 For example:
5031 @itemize @bullet
5032 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5033 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5034 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5035 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5036 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5037 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5038 to set up system clocks or
5039 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5040 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5041 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5042 @end itemize
5043
5044 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5045 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5046 @command{target create ... -event}.
5047
5048 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5049 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5050 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5051
5052 @example
5053 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5054 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5055 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5056 @}
5057 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5058 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5059 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5060 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5061 @}
5062 @end example
5063
5064 The following target events are defined:
5065
5066 @itemize @bullet
5067 @item @b{debug-halted}
5068 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5069 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5070 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5071 @item @b{early-halted}
5072 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5073 @item @b{examine-start}
5074 @* Before target examine is called.
5075 @item @b{examine-end}
5076 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5077 @item @b{examine-fail}
5078 @* After target examine fails.
5079 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5080 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5081 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5082 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5083 connect GDB to running target.
5084 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5085 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5086 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5087 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5088 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5089 is in RAM or read only memory.
5090 Default is @code{halt}
5091 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5092 @* When GDB disconnects
5093 @item @b{gdb-end}
5094 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5095 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5096 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5097 @code{reset init})
5098 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5099 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5100 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5101 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5102 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5103 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5104 @item @b{gdb-start}
5105 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5106 @item @b{halted}
5107 @* The target has halted
5108 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5109 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5110 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5111 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5112 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5113 @item @b{reset-assert}
5114 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5115 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5116 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5117 it instead of asserting SRST.
5118 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5119 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5120 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5121 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5122 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5123 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5124 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5125 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5126 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5127 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5128 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5129 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5130 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5131 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5132 released on the scan chain.
5133 @item @b{reset-end}
5134 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5135 @item @b{reset-init}
5136 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5137 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5138
5139 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5140 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5141 multiplexing, and so on.
5142 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5143 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5144 @item @b{reset-start}
5145 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5146 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5147
5148 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5149 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5150 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5151 @item @b{resume-start}
5152 @* Before any target is resumed
5153 @item @b{resume-end}
5154 @* After all targets have resumed
5155 @item @b{resumed}
5156 @* Target has resumed
5157 @item @b{step-start}
5158 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5159 @item @b{step-end}
5160 @* After single-step has completed
5161 @item @b{trace-config}
5162 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5163 @end itemize
5164
5165 @quotation Note
5166 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5167 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5168 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5169 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5170 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5171 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5172 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5173 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5174 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5175 check if the core has changed status.
5176 @end quotation
5177
5178 @node Flash Commands
5179 @chapter Flash Commands
5180
5181 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5182 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5183 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5184 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5185 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5186 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5187 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5188 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5189 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5190
5191 Flash Steps:
5192 @enumerate
5193 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5194 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5195 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5196 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5197 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5198 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5199 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5200 @item GDB Flashing
5201 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5202 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5203 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5204 @end enumerate
5205
5206 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5207 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5208 so that it can't boot.
5209 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5210 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5211
5212 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5213 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5214 @cindex flash configuration
5215
5216 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5217 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5218 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5219 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5220 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5221 see the driver-specific documentation.
5222
5223 @itemize @bullet
5224 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5225 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5226 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5227 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5228 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5229 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5230 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5231 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5232 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5233 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5234 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5235 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5236 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5237 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5238 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5239 commands to the flash controller.
5240 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5241 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5242 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5243 for more information.
5244 @end itemize
5245 @quotation Note
5246 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5247 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5248 @end quotation
5249 @end deffn
5250
5251 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5252 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5253 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5254 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5255 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5256 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5257 @end deffn
5258
5259 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5260 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5261 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5262 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5263 @end deffn
5264
5265 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5266 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5267 depends on the flash type.
5268 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5269 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5270 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5271 but most don't bother.
5272 @end deffn
5273
5274 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5275
5276 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5277 begins.
5278
5279 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5280 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5281 until the programming session is finished.
5282
5283 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5284 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5285
5286 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5287
5288 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5289 @cindex flash erasing
5290 @cindex flash reading
5291 @cindex flash writing
5292 @cindex flash programming
5293 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5294
5295 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5296 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5297 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5298 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5299 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5300
5301 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5302 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5303 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5304 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5305 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5306
5307 @quotation Note
5308 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5309 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5310 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5311 back to a flash bank.
5312 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5313 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5314 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5315 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5316 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5317 @end quotation
5318
5319 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5320 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5321 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5322 disabled first.
5323 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5324 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5325 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5326
5327 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5328 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5329 up to and including @var{last}.
5330 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5331 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5332 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5333 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5334 @end deffn
5335
5336 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5337 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5338 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5339 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5340 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5341 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5342 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5343 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5344 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5345 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5346 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5347 before erase starts.
5348 @end deffn
5349
5350 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5351 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5352 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5353 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5354 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5355 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5356 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5357 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5358 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5359 before issuing this command.
5360 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5361 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5362 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5363 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5364 @end deffn
5365 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5366
5367 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5368 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5369 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5370 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5371 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5372 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5373 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5374 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5375 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5376 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5377 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5378 @end deffn
5379
5380 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5381 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5382 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5383 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5384 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5385 @end deffn
5386
5387 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5388 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5389 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5390 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5391 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5392 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5393 @end deffn
5394
5395 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5396 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5397 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5398 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5399 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5400 @end deffn
5401
5402 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5403 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5404 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5405 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5406 to the base address for each section in the image.
5407 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5408 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5409 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5410 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5411 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5412 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5413 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5414 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5415 each image section.
5416
5417 @quotation Warning
5418 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5419 data you want to preserve.
5420 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5421 sections might be erased with no notice.
5422 @itemize
5423 @item
5424 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5425 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5426 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5427 @item
5428 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5429 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5430 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5431 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5432 @end itemize
5433 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5434 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5435 @end quotation
5436
5437 @end deffn
5438
5439 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5440 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5441 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5442 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5443 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5444 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5445 ordinary memory reads.
5446 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5447 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5448 check for successful programming.
5449 @end deffn
5450
5451 @section Other Flash commands
5452 @cindex flash protection
5453
5454 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5455 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5456 and display that status.
5457 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5458 @end deffn
5459
5460 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5461 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5462 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5463
5464 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5465 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5466 and possibly stale information.
5467 @end deffn
5468
5469 @anchor{flashprotect}
5470 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5471 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5472 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5473 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5474 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5475 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5476 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5477 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5478 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5479 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5480 @end deffn
5481
5482 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5483 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5484 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5485 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5486 @end deffn
5487
5488 @anchor{program}
5489 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5490 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5491 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5492 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5493 @end deffn
5494
5495 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5496 @section Flash Driver List
5497 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5498 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5499 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5500
5501 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5502 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5503 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5504
5505 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5506
5507 @itemize
5508 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5509 @end itemize
5510
5511 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5512 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5513 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5514 @example
5515 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5516 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5517 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5518 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5519 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5520 @end example
5521 @end deffn
5522
5523 @subsection External Flash
5524
5525 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5526 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5527 @cindex CFI
5528 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5529 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5530 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5531 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5532 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5533 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5534 configure a bus and its timings), or
5535 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5536 on the flash chip.
5537 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5538 speed up operation.
5539
5540 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5541
5542 @itemize
5543 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5544 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5545 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5546 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5547 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5548 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5549 @end itemize
5550
5551 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5552 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5553
5554 @example
5555 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5556 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5557 @end example
5558
5559 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5560 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5561 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5562
5563 @example
5564 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5565 @end example
5566
5567 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5568 @end deffn
5569
5570 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5571 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5572 @cindex SPI
5573 @cindex jtagspi
5574 @cindex bscan_spi
5575 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5576 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5577 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5578 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5579 accessed through JTAG.
5580
5581 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5582 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5583 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5584 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5585 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5586 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5587
5588 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5589 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5590 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5591 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5592 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5593 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5594 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5595 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5596
5597 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5598 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5599 command, see below.
5600
5601 @itemize
5602 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5603 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5604 @var{USER1} instruction.
5605 @end itemize
5606
5607 @example
5608 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5609 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5610 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5611 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5612 @end example
5613
5614 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5615 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5616 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5617 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5618 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5619 @example
5620 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5621 @end example
5622 @end deffn
5623
5624 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5625 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5626 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5627 @example
5628 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5629 @end example
5630 @end deffn
5631
5632 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5633 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5634 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5635 @end deffn
5636 @end deffn
5637
5638 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5639 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5640 @cindex xcf
5641 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5642 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5643 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5644 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5645 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5646
5647 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5648 command accepts additional parameters:
5649 @itemize
5650 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5651 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5652 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5653 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5654 in master mode.
5655 @end itemize
5656 @example
5657 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5658 @end example
5659 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5660 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5661 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5662 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5663 dedicated sector.
5664 @end deffn
5665
5666 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5667 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5668 button.
5669 @example
5670 xcf configure 0
5671 @end example
5672 @end deffn
5673
5674 Additional driver notes:
5675 @itemize
5676 @item Only single revision supported.
5677 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5678 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5679 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5680 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5681 @end itemize
5682 @end deffn
5683
5684 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5685 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5686 @cindex SPIFI
5687 @cindex lpcspifi
5688 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5689 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5690 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5691
5692 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5693 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5694 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5695 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5696 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5697
5698 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5699 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5700 are configured by the driver.
5701
5702 @example
5703 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5704 @end example
5705
5706 @end deffn
5707
5708 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5709 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5710 @cindex SMI
5711 @cindex stmsmi
5712 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5713 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5714 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5715 SPI flash devices.
5716 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5717 flash devices can be connected.
5718
5719 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5720 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5721 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5722 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5723 the flash content.
5724
5725 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5726 to identify the memory bank.
5727 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5728 flash size, are detected automatically.
5729
5730 @example
5731 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5732 @end example
5733
5734 @end deffn
5735
5736 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5737 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5738 @cindex QuadSPI
5739 @cindex OctoSPI
5740 @cindex stmqspi
5741 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5742 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5743 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5744 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5745 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5746 mode is not.
5747
5748 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5749 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5750 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5751 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5752
5753 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5754 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5755 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5756
5757 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5758 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5759 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5760 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5761 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5762 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5763
5764 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5765 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5766 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5767 should be avoided.
5768
5769 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5770 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5771 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5772 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5773 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5774 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5775
5776 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5777 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5778 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5779 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5780 persist across openocd invocations.
5781
5782 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5783 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5784 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5785 required (see 'set' command).
5786
5787 @example
5788 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5789 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5790 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5791 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5792 @end example
5793
5794 There are three specific commands
5795 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5796 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5797 chip specific write protection engaged.
5798 @end deffn
5799
5800 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5801 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5802 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5803 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5804 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5805 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5806
5807 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5808 which don't support an id command.
5809
5810 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5811 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5812 @end deffn
5813
5814 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5815 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5816 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5817 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5818 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5819
5820 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5821 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5822 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5823 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5824
5825 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5826
5827 To check basic communication settings, issue
5828 @example
5829 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5830 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5831 @end example
5832 for single flash mode or
5833 @example
5834 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5835 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5836 @end example
5837 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5838
5839 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5840 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5841 need a dummy address, e.g.
5842 @example
5843 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5844 @end example
5845 should return the status register contents.
5846
5847 @end deffn
5848
5849 @end deffn
5850
5851 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5852 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5853 Microcontroller platform.
5854
5855 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5856 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5857
5858 @example
5859 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5860 @end example
5861
5862 @end deffn
5863
5864 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5865 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5866 @cindex ath79
5867 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5868 chip selects.
5869 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5870 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5871 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5872 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5873 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5874 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5875
5876 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5877 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5878 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5879 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5880 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5881 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5882 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5883 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5884 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5885 with the default CS0.
5886 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5887 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5888 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5889
5890 @example
5891 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5892
5893 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5894 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5895 # distinguish the banks.
5896 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5897 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5898 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5899 @end example
5900
5901 @end deffn
5902
5903 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5904 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5905 @cindex fespi
5906
5907 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5908
5909 @example
5910 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5911 @end example
5912 @end deffn
5913
5914 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5915
5916 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5917 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5918 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5919 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5920 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5921 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5922
5923 @example
5924 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5925 @end example
5926 @end deffn
5927
5928 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5929 @cindex ambiqmicro
5930 @cindex apollo
5931 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5932 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5933 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5934 with the target using SWD.
5935
5936 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5937 the device class of the MCU.
5938 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5939 to set up the flash banks.
5940 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5941 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5942
5943 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5944 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5945 and the second bank starts after the first.
5946
5947 @example
5948 # Flash bank 0
5949 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5950 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5951 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5952 $_TARGETNAME
5953 @end example
5954
5955 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5956 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5957 are available to the user.
5958
5959 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5960
5961 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5962 Erase entire bank.
5963 @end deffn
5964 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5965 Erase device pages.
5966 @end deffn
5967 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5968 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5969 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5970 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5971 the flash.
5972 @end deffn
5973 @end deffn
5974
5975 @anchor{at91samd}
5976 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5977 @cindex at91samd
5978 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5979 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5980
5981 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5982
5983 The devices have one flash bank:
5984
5985 @example
5986 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5987 @end example
5988
5989 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5990 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5991 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5992 processor to be halted.
5993 @end deffn
5994
5995 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5996 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5997 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5998 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5999 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6000 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6001
6002 @example
6003 at91samd set-security enable
6004 @end example
6005 @end deffn
6006
6007 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6008 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6009 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6010 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6011 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6012 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6013 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6014 in order to disable this feature.
6015
6016 @example
6017 at91samd eeprom
6018 at91samd eeprom 1024
6019 @end example
6020 @end deffn
6021
6022 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6023 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6024 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6025 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6026 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6027 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6028
6029 @example
6030 at91samd bootloader
6031 at91samd bootloader 16384
6032 @end example
6033 @end deffn
6034
6035 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6036 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6037 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6038 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6039 @end deffn
6040
6041 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6042 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6043 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6044 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6045 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6046 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6047 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6048 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6049
6050 @example
6051 # Read user row
6052 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6053 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6054 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6055 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6056 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6057 # byte unchanged
6058 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6059 @end example
6060 @end deffn
6061
6062 @end deffn
6063
6064 @anchor{at91sam3}
6065 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6066 @cindex at91sam3
6067 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6068 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6069 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6070 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6071 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6072 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6073 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6074 chips are confirmed.}
6075
6076 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6077 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6078 the following fixed locations:
6079
6080 @example
6081 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6082 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6083 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6084 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6085 @end example
6086
6087 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6088 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6089 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6090
6091 @itemize
6092 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6093 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6094 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6095 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6096 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6097 @end itemize
6098
6099 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6100
6101 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6102 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6103 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6104 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6105 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6106 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6107 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6108
6109 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6110 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6111 @end deffn
6112
6113 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6114 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6115 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6116 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6117 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6118 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6119 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6120 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6121 @end deffn
6122
6123 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6124 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6125 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6126 @end deffn
6127 @end deffn
6128
6129 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6130 @cindex at91sam4
6131 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6132 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6133 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6134 @end deffn
6135
6136 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6137 @cindex at91sam4l
6138 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6139 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6140 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6141
6142 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6143 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6144 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6145 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6146 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6147 @end deffn
6148 @end deffn
6149
6150 @anchor{atsame5}
6151 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6152 @cindex atsame5
6153 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6154 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6155 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6156
6157 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6158 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6159 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6160
6161 @example
6162 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6163 @end example
6164
6165 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6166 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6167 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6168 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6169 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6170 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6171
6172 @example
6173 atsame5 bootloader
6174 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6175 @end example
6176 @end deffn
6177
6178 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6179 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6180 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6181 processor to be halted.
6182 @end deffn
6183
6184 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6185 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6186 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6187 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6188 @end deffn
6189
6190 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6191 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6192 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6193 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6194 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6195 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6196 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6197 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6198
6199 @example
6200 # Read
6201 >atsame5 userpage
6202 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6203 # Write
6204 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6205 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6206 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6207 # bytes)
6208 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6209 @end example
6210 @end deffn
6211
6212 @end deffn
6213
6214 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6215 @cindex atsamv
6216 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6217 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6218 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6219 @end deffn
6220
6221 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6222 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6223 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6224 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6225 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6226
6227 @example
6228 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6229 @end example
6230
6231 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6232 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6233
6234 @itemize
6235 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6236 @item @var{banks}
6237 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6238 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6239 @item @var{pages_size}
6240 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6241 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6242 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6243 @end itemize
6244
6245 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6246 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6247 will be autoconfigured.
6248 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6249
6250 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6251 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6252 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6253 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6254 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6255
6256 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6257 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6258 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6259 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6260 are not truly general purpose).
6261 @quotation Note
6262 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6263 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6264 @end quotation
6265 @end deffn
6266 @end deffn
6267
6268 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6269 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6270 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6271 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6272 @end deffn
6273
6274 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6275 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6276 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6277 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6278
6279 @example
6280 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6281 @end example
6282
6283 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6284 each single sector one by one.
6285
6286 @example
6287 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6288 @end example
6289
6290 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6291 @end deffn
6292
6293 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6294 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6295 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6296 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6297 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6298 starts at address 0.
6299
6300 @example
6301 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6302 @end example
6303 @end deffn
6304
6305 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6306 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6307 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6308 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6309 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6310 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6311 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6312 and programming the serial flash.
6313
6314 @example
6315 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6316 @end example
6317 @end deffn
6318
6319 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6320 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6321 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6322 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6323 autoconfigures itself.
6324 @example
6325 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6326 @end example
6327 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6328 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6329 this via the following command:
6330 @example
6331 efm32 debuglock num
6332 @end example
6333 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6334 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6335 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6336 supported.}
6337 @end deffn
6338
6339 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6340 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6341 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6342 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6343 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6344 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6345
6346 @example
6347 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6348 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6349 @end example
6350
6351 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6352 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6353 @end deffn
6354
6355 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6356 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6357 is an uncommon operation.}
6358 @end deffn
6359 @end deffn
6360
6361 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6362 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6363 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6364 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6365 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6366 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6367 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6368
6369 @example
6370 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6371 @end example
6372 @end deffn
6373
6374 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6375 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6376 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6377 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6378 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6379 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6380 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6381 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6382 characters) ignored.
6383
6384 @example
6385 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6386 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6387 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6388 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6389 @end example
6390 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6391 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6392 @end deffn
6393
6394 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6395 @cindex kinetis
6396 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6397 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6398 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6399 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6400 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6401 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6402
6403 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6404 @itemize
6405 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6406 @end itemize
6407
6408 @example
6409 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6410 @end example
6411
6412 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6413 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6414 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6415 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6416 @end deffn
6417
6418 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6419 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6420 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6421 set by 'flash protect' command.
6422 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6423 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6424 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6425 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6426 with the rest of a flash image.
6427 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6428 @end deffn
6429
6430 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6431 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6432 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6433 @end deffn
6434
6435 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6436 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6437 and examine-fail event.
6438 @end deffn
6439
6440 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6441 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6442 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6443 @end deffn
6444
6445 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6446 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6447 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6448 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6449 command completes.
6450 @end deffn
6451
6452 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6453 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6454 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6455 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6456 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6457
6458 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6459 Program Partition command.
6460
6461 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6462 Reset the device after partition setting.
6463
6464 Show partition size:
6465 @example
6466 kinetis nvm_partition info
6467 @end example
6468
6469 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6470 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6471 @example
6472 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6473 @end example
6474
6475 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6476 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6477 @example
6478 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6479 @end example
6480 @end deffn
6481
6482 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6483 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6484 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6485 @end deffn
6486
6487 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6488 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6489 Command disables watchdog timer.
6490 @end deffn
6491 @end deffn
6492
6493 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6494 @cindex kinetis_ke
6495 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6496 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6497 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6498 autoconfigures itself.
6499 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6500
6501 @example
6502 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6503 @end example
6504
6505 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6506 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6507 @end deffn
6508
6509 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6510 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6511 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6512 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6513 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6514 @end deffn
6515
6516 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6517 Command disables watchdog timer.
6518 @end deffn
6519 @end deffn
6520
6521 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6522 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6523 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6524 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6525 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6526
6527 @quotation Note
6528 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6529 driver:
6530 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6531 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6532 @end quotation
6533
6534 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6535 which must appear in the following order:
6536
6537 @itemize
6538 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6539 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6540 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6541 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6542 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6543 LPC43x[2357])
6544 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6545 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6546 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6547 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6548 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6549 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6550 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6551 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6552 at which the core is running
6553 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6554 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6555 @quotation Note
6556 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6557 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6558 However, if you do provide it,
6559 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6560 @end quotation
6561 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6562 ROM IAP entry point.
6563 @end itemize
6564
6565 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6566
6567 @example
6568 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6569 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6570 @end example
6571
6572 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6573 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6574 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6575 @end deffn
6576 @end deffn
6577
6578 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6579 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6580 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6581 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6582 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6583 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6584
6585 @example
6586 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6587 @end example
6588 @end deffn
6589
6590 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6591 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6592 from NXP.
6593
6594 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6595 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6596 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6597 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6598 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6599 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6600 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6601 you start the PLL.
6602
6603 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6604
6605 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6606 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6607 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6608
6609 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6610 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6611 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6612 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6613 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6614 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6615 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6616
6617 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6618 @example
6619 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6620 @end example
6621
6622 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6623 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6624 @code{flash banks} command.
6625
6626 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6627 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6628 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6629 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6630 a known signature.
6631 Example:
6632 @example
6633 lpc2900 signature 0
6634 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6635 @end example
6636 @end deffn
6637
6638 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6639 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6640 saves it to a file in binary format.
6641 Example:
6642 @example
6643 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6644 @end example
6645 @end deffn
6646
6647 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6648 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6649 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6650 command:
6651
6652 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6653 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6654 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6655 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6656
6657 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6658 Example:
6659 @example
6660 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6661 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6662 @end example
6663 @end deffn
6664
6665 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6666 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6667 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6668 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6669 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6670 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6671 912 bytes.
6672 @quotation Attention
6673 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6674 @end quotation
6675 Example:
6676 @example
6677 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6678 @end example
6679 @end deffn
6680
6681 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6682 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6683 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6684 after the next power cycle.
6685 @quotation Attention
6686 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6687 @end quotation
6688 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6689 Example:
6690 @example
6691 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6692 flash info 0
6693 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6694 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6695 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6696 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6697 @end example
6698 @end deffn
6699
6700 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6701 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6702 effective after the next power cycle.
6703 @quotation Attention
6704 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6705 @end quotation
6706 Examples:
6707 @example
6708 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6709 @end example
6710 @end deffn
6711 @end deffn
6712
6713 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6714 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6715 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6716 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6717
6718 @example
6719 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6720 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6721 @end example
6722
6723 @itemize @bullet
6724 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6725 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6726 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6727 @end itemize
6728
6729 Example usage:
6730 @example
6731 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6732 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6733 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6734 @} else @{
6735 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6736 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6737 @}
6738 @end example
6739 @end deffn
6740
6741 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6742 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6743 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6744 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6745 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6746 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6747
6748 @example
6749 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6750 @end example
6751
6752 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6753 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6754 only the main program flash.
6755
6756 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6757 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6758 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6759 @end deffn
6760
6761 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6762 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6763 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6764 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6765
6766 To erase and program the BSL:
6767 @example
6768 msp432 bsl unlock
6769 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6770 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6771 msp432 bsl lock
6772 @end example
6773 @end deffn
6774 @end deffn
6775
6776 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6777 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6778 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6779 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6780 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6781 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6782 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6783 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6784 also have division into regions: main and info.
6785 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6786 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6787
6788 @example
6789 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6790 @end example
6791
6792 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6793
6794 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6795 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6796 @end deffn
6797
6798 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6799 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6800 @end deffn
6801
6802 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6803 Erase all userflash including info region.
6804 @end deffn
6805
6806 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6807 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6808 @end deffn
6809
6810 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6811 Check sectors protect.
6812 @end deffn
6813
6814 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6815 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6816 @end deffn
6817
6818 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6819 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6820 @end deffn
6821
6822 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6823 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6824 @end deffn
6825
6826 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6827 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6828 @end deffn
6829
6830 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6831 Show information about flash driver.
6832 @end deffn
6833
6834 @end deffn
6835
6836 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6837 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6838 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6839 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6840 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6841
6842 @example
6843 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6844 @end example
6845 @end deffn
6846
6847 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6848 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6849 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6850 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6851 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6852
6853 @example
6854 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6855 @end example
6856
6857 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6858
6859 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6860 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6861 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6862 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6863 code.
6864 @end deffn
6865
6866 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6867 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6868 @end deffn
6869
6870 @end deffn
6871
6872 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6873 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6874 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6875
6876 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6877 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6878 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6879 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6880
6881 @example
6882 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6883 @end example
6884 @end deffn
6885
6886 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6887 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6888 and integrate flash memory.
6889
6890 @example
6891 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6892 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6893 @end example
6894
6895 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6896 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6897 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6898 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6899 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6900 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6901 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6902 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6903 @end deffn
6904 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6905 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6906 This will remove any Code Protection.
6907 @end deffn
6908 @end deffn
6909
6910 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6911 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6912 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6913 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6914 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6915
6916 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6917 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6918
6919 @example
6920 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6921 @end example
6922
6923 psoc4-specific commands
6924 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6925 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6926
6927 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6928 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6929
6930 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6931 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6932 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6933
6934 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6935 @end deffn
6936
6937 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6938 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6939
6940 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6941 @end deffn
6942 @end deffn
6943
6944 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6945 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6946 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6947 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6948 apart from the base address.
6949
6950 @example
6951 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6952 @end example
6953
6954 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6955 @quotation Attention
6956 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6957 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6958 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6959 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6960 @end quotation
6961
6962 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6963
6964 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6965 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6966 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6967 @end deffn
6968 @end deffn
6969
6970 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6971 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6972 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6973 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6974 apart from the base address.
6975
6976 @example
6977 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6978 $_TARGETNAME
6979 @end example
6980 @end deffn
6981
6982 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6983 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6984 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6985 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6986
6987 @example
6988 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6989 @end example
6990
6991 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6992
6993 @itemize
6994 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6995 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6996 @end itemize
6997
6998 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6999
7000 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7001 @quotation Attention
7002 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7003 after successful write.
7004 @end quotation
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7008 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7009 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7010 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7011
7012 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7013 @itemize @bullet
7014 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7015 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7016 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7017 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7018 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7019 row size: 512 bytes.
7020 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7021 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7022 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7023 operation will erase row automatically.
7024 @end itemize
7025
7026 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7027 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7028
7029 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7030
7031 @example
7032 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7033 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7034 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7035 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7036 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7037 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7038 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7039 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7040 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7041 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7042 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7043 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7044
7045 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7046 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7047 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7048 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7049 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7050 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7051 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7052 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7053 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7054 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7055 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7056 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7057 @end example
7058
7059 psoc6-specific commands
7060 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7061 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7062 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7063 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7064 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7065 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7066 @end deffn
7067
7068 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7069 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7070 by @command{flash banks}.
7071 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7072 @end deffn
7073 @end deffn
7074
7075 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7076 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7077 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7078 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7079 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7080
7081 @example
7082 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7083 @end example
7084 @end deffn
7085
7086 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7087 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7088 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7089 and SWD interface.
7090 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7091 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7092
7093 @example
7094 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7095 @end example
7096
7097 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7098
7099 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7100 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7101 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7105 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7106 @end deffn
7107 @end deffn
7108
7109 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7110 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7111 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7112 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7113 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7114
7115 @example
7116 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7117 @end example
7118
7119 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7120 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7121 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7122 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7123 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7124 disabled.
7125
7126 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7127 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7128 @quotation Warning
7129 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7130 applied to all of them.
7131 @end quotation
7132 @end deffn
7133 @end deffn
7134
7135 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7136 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7137 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7138 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7139 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7140 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7141
7142 @example
7143 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7144 @end example
7145
7146 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7147 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7148 the flash driver.
7149
7150 @example
7151 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7152 @end example
7153
7154 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7155 as per the following example.
7156 @example
7157 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7158 @end example
7159
7160 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7161
7162 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7163 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7164 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7165 @end deffn
7166
7167 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7168 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7169 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7170 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7171 @end deffn
7172
7173 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7174 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7175 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7176 @end deffn
7177
7178 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7179 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7180 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7181 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7182 @end deffn
7183
7184 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7185 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7186 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7187 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7191 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7192 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7193 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7194 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7195 @end deffn
7196 @end deffn
7197
7198 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7199 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7200 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7201 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7202 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7203
7204 @example
7205 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7206 @end example
7207
7208 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7209 as per the following example.
7210 @example
7211 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7212 @end example
7213
7214 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7215 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7216 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7217 @end deffn
7218
7219 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7220 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7221 the flash driver.
7222
7223 @example
7224 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7225 @end example
7226
7227 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7228
7229 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7230 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7231 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7232 @end deffn
7233
7234 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7235 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7236 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7237 @end deffn
7238
7239 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7240 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7241 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7242 @end deffn
7243
7244 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7245 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7246 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7247 @end deffn
7248
7249 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7250 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7251 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7252 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7253 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7254 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7255 @end deffn
7256
7257 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7258 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7259 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7260 @end deffn
7261 @end deffn
7262
7263 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7264 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7265 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7266 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7267 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7268
7269 @example
7270 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7271 @end example
7272
7273 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7274 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7275 the flash driver.
7276
7277 @example
7278 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7279 @end example
7280
7281 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7282
7283 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7284 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7285 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7286 @end deffn
7287
7288 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7289 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7290 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7291 @end deffn
7292
7293 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7294 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7295 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7296 @end deffn
7297
7298 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7299 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7300 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7301 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7302 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7303
7304 Example usage:
7305 @example
7306 # read OPTSR_CUR
7307 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7308 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7309 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7310 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7311 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7312 @end example
7313 @end deffn
7314
7315 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7316 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7317 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7318 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7319 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7320 will be touched).
7321
7322 Example usage:
7323 @example
7324 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7325 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7326 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7327 @end example
7328 @end deffn
7329 @end deffn
7330
7331 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7332 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7333 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7334 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7335 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7336
7337 @example
7338 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7339 @end example
7340
7341 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7342 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7343 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7344 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7345 second bank.
7346
7347 @example
7348 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7349 @end example
7350
7351 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7352
7353 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7354 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7355 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7359 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7360 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7361 @end deffn
7362
7363 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7364 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7365 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7366 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7367 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7368 @end deffn
7369 @end deffn
7370
7371 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7372 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7373 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7374 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7375 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7376 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7377
7378 @example
7379 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7380 @end example
7381
7382 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7383 as per the following example.
7384 @example
7385 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7386 @end example
7387
7388 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7389 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7390 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7394 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7395 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7396 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7397
7398 @example
7399 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7400 @end example
7401
7402 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7403
7404 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7405 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7406 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7407
7408 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7409 @end deffn
7410
7411 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7412 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7413 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7414
7415 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7416 @end deffn
7417
7418 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7419 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7420 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7421 @end deffn
7422
7423 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7424 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7425 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7426 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7427
7428 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7429 @example
7430 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7431 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7432 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7433 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7434 @end example
7435
7436 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7437 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7441 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7442 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7443 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7444 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7445
7446 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7447
7448 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7449 @example
7450 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7451 @end example
7452
7453 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7454 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7455 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7456 @end deffn
7457
7458 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7459 List the protected areas using WRP.
7460 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7461 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7462 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7463
7464 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7465 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7466 in single or dual-banks mode.
7467 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7468 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7469
7470 @end deffn
7471
7472 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7473 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7474 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7475 @end deffn
7476
7477 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7478 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7479 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7480 the TrustZone status.
7481 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7482 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7483 @end deffn
7484 @end deffn
7485
7486 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7487 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7488 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7489 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7490 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7491
7492 @example
7493 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7494 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7495 @end example
7496
7497 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7498 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7499 for the specified flash bank.
7500 @end deffn
7501 @end deffn
7502
7503 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7504 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7505 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7506 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7507 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7508
7509 @example
7510 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7511 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7512 @end example
7513
7514 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7515 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7516 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7517
7518 @itemize @bullet
7519 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7520 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7521 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7522 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7523 @end itemize
7524 @end deffn
7525
7526 @end deffn
7527
7528 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7529 @cindex str9xpec
7530
7531 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7532 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7533 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7534 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7535
7536 Here is some background info to help
7537 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7538 the str9:
7539 @enumerate
7540 @item
7541 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7542 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7543 @item
7544 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7545 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7546 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7547 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7548 @end enumerate
7549
7550 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7551 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7552 configured for flash bank 0.
7553 @example
7554 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7555 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7556 adapter assert srst
7557 # turn off target polling
7558 poll off
7559 # disable str9 core
7560 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7561 # read option bytes
7562 str9xpec options_read 0
7563 # re-enable str9 core
7564 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7565 poll on
7566 reset halt
7567 @end example
7568 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7569 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7570 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7571 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7572
7573 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7574
7575 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7576 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7577 @end deffn
7578
7579 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7580 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7581 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7585 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7586 erase the device.
7587 @end deffn
7588
7589 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7590 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7594 Configure str9 boot bank.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7598 Configure str9 lvd source.
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7602 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7603 @end deffn
7604
7605 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7606 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7607 @end deffn
7608
7609 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7610 Read str9 option bytes.
7611 @end deffn
7612
7613 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7614 Write str9 option bytes.
7615 @end deffn
7616
7617 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7618 unlock str9 device.
7619 @end deffn
7620
7621 @end deffn
7622
7623 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7624 @cindex swm050
7625 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7626
7627 @example
7628 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7629 @end example
7630
7631 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7632
7633 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7634 Erases the entire flash bank.
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @end deffn
7638
7639
7640 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7641 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7642 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7643 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7644
7645 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7646
7647 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7648 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7649 @end deffn
7650
7651 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7652 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7653 @end deffn
7654
7655 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7656 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7657 the flash clock.
7658 @end deffn
7659 @end deffn
7660
7661 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7662 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7663 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7664 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7665 correct bank config.
7666
7667 @example
7668 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7669 @end example
7670 @end deffn
7671
7672 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7673 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7674 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7675 @end deffn
7676
7677 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7678 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7679 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7680
7681 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7682
7683 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7684 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7685 @end deffn
7686
7687 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7688 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7689 @end deffn
7690
7691 @end deffn
7692
7693 @section NAND Flash Commands
7694 @cindex NAND
7695
7696 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7697 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7698 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7699
7700 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7701 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7702 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7703 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7704 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7705 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7706
7707 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7708 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7709 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7710 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7711 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7712 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7713 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7714 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7715 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7716 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7717
7718 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7719 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7720 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7721 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7722 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7723 every 512 bytes of data.
7724
7725 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7726 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7727 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7728 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7729 ECC mode is used.
7730
7731 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7732 @enumerate
7733 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7734 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7735 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7736 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7737 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7738 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7739 to access that device.
7740 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7741 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7742 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7743 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7744 de-brick a board.
7745 @end enumerate
7746
7747 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7748 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7749 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7750 are only 32 bits wide.
7751 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7752 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7753 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7754 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7755
7756 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7757 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7758 @cindex NAND configuration
7759
7760 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7761 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7762 OpenOCD has initialized.
7763
7764 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7765 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7766 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7767 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7768 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7769 they were a single (larger) device.
7770 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7771 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7772
7773 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7774 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7775 configuration files, not interactively.
7776
7777 @itemize @bullet
7778 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7779 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7780 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7781 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7782 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7783 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7784 commands to the NAND controller.
7785 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7786 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7787 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7788 for more information.
7789 @end itemize
7790 @end deffn
7791
7792 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7793 Prints a summary of each device declared
7794 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7795 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7796 @example
7797 > nand list
7798 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7799 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7800 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7801 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7802 >
7803 @end example
7804 @end deffn
7805
7806 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7807 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7808 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7809 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7810 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7811 it with most other NAND commands.
7812 @end deffn
7813
7814 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7815
7816 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7817 @cindex NAND reading
7818 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7819 starting at the specified offset.
7820 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7821
7822 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7823 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7824
7825 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7826 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7827 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7828
7829 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7830 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7831 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7832 method which handled that error correction.
7833
7834 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7835 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7836 @itemize @bullet
7837 @item no oob_* parameter
7838 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7839 @item @code{oob_raw}
7840 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7841 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7842 spare areas associated with each data page.
7843 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7844 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7845 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7846 @item @code{oob_only}
7847 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7848 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7849 spare areas associated with each data page.
7850 @end itemize
7851 @end deffn
7852
7853 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7854 @cindex NAND erasing
7855 @cindex NAND programming
7856 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7857 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7858 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7859 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7860 If those parameters are not specified,
7861 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7862 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7863
7864 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7865 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7866 block marker.
7867 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7868 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7872 @cindex NAND writing
7873 @cindex NAND programming
7874 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7875 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7876 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7877 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7878
7879 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7880 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7881
7882 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7883 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7884 past the end of the device.
7885 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7886 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7887 if that's being written.)
7888
7889 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7890 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7891 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7892
7893 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7894 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7895 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7896 @itemize @bullet
7897 @item no oob_* parameter
7898 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7899 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7900 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7901 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7902 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7903 @item @code{oob_only}
7904 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7905 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7906 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7907 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7908 @item @code{oob_raw}
7909 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7910 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7911 un-altered OOB.
7912 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7913 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7914 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7915 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7916 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7917 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7918 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7919 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7920 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7921 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7922 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7923 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7924 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7925 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7926 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7927 @end itemize
7928 @end deffn
7929
7930 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7931 @cindex NAND verification
7932 @cindex NAND programming
7933 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7934 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7935 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7936
7937 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7938 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7939
7940 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7941 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7942 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7943 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7944 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7945
7946 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7947 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7948 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7949
7950 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7951 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7952 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7953 be removed in a future release.
7954 @end deffn
7955
7956 @subsection Other NAND commands
7957 @cindex NAND other commands
7958
7959 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7960 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7961 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7962 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7963 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7964 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7965 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7966 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7967
7968 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7969 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7970 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7971 @end deffn
7972
7973 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7974 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7975 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7976 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7977 status for each block.
7978 @end deffn
7979
7980 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7981 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7982 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7983
7984 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7985 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7986 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7987 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7988 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7989
7990 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7991 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7992 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7993 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7994 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7995 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7996 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7997 @end deffn
7998
7999 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8000 @subsection NAND Driver List
8001 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8002 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8003 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8004
8005 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8006 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8007 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8008 address of the ECC controller.
8009 @example
8010 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8011 @end example
8012 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8013 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8014 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8015 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8016 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8017 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8018 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8019 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8020 @end deffn
8021 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8022 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8023 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8024 @end deffn
8025
8026 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8027 properly configured for input or output.
8028 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8029 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8030 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8031 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8032 @end deffn
8033 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8034 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8035 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8036 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8037 @end deffn
8038 @end deffn
8039
8040 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8041 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8042 chips from Texas Instruments.
8043 It takes three extra parameters:
8044 address of the NAND chip;
8045 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8046 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8047 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8048 @example
8049 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8050 @end example
8051 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8052 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8053 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8054 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8055 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8056 @end deffn
8057
8058 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8059 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8060 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8061 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8062 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8063 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8064 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8065 @end deffn
8066
8067 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8068 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8069 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8070 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8071 @end deffn
8072 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8073
8074 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8075 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8076 should work for this chip as well.
8077 @end deffn
8078
8079 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8080 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8081 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8082 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8083 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8084 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8085 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8086 @example
8087 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8088 @end example
8089 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8090 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8091 without parameter query status.
8092 @end deffn
8093 @end deffn
8094
8095 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8096 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8097 parameter: the address of the controller.
8098 @example
8099 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8100 @end example
8101 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8102 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8103 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8104 change any behavior.
8105 @end deffn
8106
8107 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8108 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8109 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8110 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8111 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8112 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8113 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8114 specialized commands.
8115 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8116 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8117 change any behavior.
8118 @end deffn
8119
8120 @node Flash Programming
8121 @chapter Flash Programming
8122
8123 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8124 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8125 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8126
8127 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8128 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8129
8130 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8131 @enumerate
8132 @item 'init' is executed.
8133 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8134 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8135 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8136 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8137 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8138 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8139 @end enumerate
8140
8141 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8142
8143 @example
8144 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8145 # are optional parameters
8146 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8147 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8148
8149 # binary files need the flash address passing
8150 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8151 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8152 @end example
8153
8154 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8155 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8156 @cindex PLD
8157 @cindex FPGA
8158
8159 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8160 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8161 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8162 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8163 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8164 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8165 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8166
8167 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8168
8169 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8170 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8171 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8172
8173 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8174 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8175
8176 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8177 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8178 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8179 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8180 behavior.
8181 @end deffn
8182
8183 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8184 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8185 @end deffn
8186
8187 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8188 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8189 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8190 @end deffn
8191
8192 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8193
8194 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8195 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8196 that particular type of PLD.
8197
8198 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8199 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8200 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8201
8202 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8203 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8204 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8205
8206 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8207 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8208 for FPGA @var{num}.
8209 @end deffn
8210 @end deffn
8211
8212 @node General Commands
8213 @chapter General Commands
8214 @cindex commands
8215
8216 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8217 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8218 commands are documented elsewhere.
8219
8220 Intent:
8221 @itemize @bullet
8222 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8223 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8224 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8225 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8226
8227 @item @b{From the human}
8228 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8229 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8230
8231 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8232 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8233 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8234
8235 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8236 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8237 port is 5555.
8238 @end itemize
8239
8240
8241 @section Server Commands
8242
8243 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8244 Exits the current telnet session.
8245 @end deffn
8246
8247 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8248 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8249 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8250 Not every command provides helptext.
8251
8252 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8253 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8254 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8255 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8256 @end deffn
8257
8258 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8259 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8260 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8261 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8262 Useful in connection with script files
8263 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8264 @end deffn
8265
8266 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8267 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8268 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8269 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8270
8271 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8272 @example
8273 # redefine shutdown
8274 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8275 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8276 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8277 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8278 original_shutdown
8279 @}
8280 @end example
8281 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8282 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8283 @end deffn
8284
8285 @anchor{debuglevel}
8286 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8287 @cindex message level
8288 Display debug level.
8289 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8290 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8291 Level 0 is error messages only;
8292 level 1 adds warnings;
8293 level 2 adds informational messages;
8294 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8295 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8296 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8297 the command line along with the location of that log
8298 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8299 @xref{Running}.
8300 @end deffn
8301
8302 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8303 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8304 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8305 @example
8306 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8307 @end example
8308 @end deffn
8309
8310 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8311 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8312 the default log output channel is stderr.
8313 @end deffn
8314
8315 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8316 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8317 @end deffn
8318
8319 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8320 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8321 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8322 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8323 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8324 @end deffn
8325
8326 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8327 @section Target State handling
8328 @cindex reset
8329 @cindex halt
8330 @cindex target initialization
8331
8332 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8333 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8334 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8335 a current target which is used to perform the
8336 various operations. The current target may be changed
8337 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8338 target which should become current.
8339
8340 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8341 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8342 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8343 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8344 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8345
8346 @emph{With no arguments}:
8347 list all available registers for the current target,
8348 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8349 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8350 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8351 are flagged as such.
8352
8353 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8354 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8355 bypassing any internal cache.
8356
8357 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8358 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8359 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8360 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8361 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8362 relevant module will flush such values.
8363
8364 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8365 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8366
8367 @example
8368 > reg
8369 ===== ARM registers
8370 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8371 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8372 (2) r2 (/32)
8373 ...
8374 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8375 >
8376 @end example
8377 @end deffn
8378
8379 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8380 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8381 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8382 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8383 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8384 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8385 (and enter debug mode).
8386 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8387
8388 @quotation Warning
8389 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8390 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8391 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8392 power mode by gating the core clock;
8393 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8394
8395 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8396 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8397 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8398 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8399 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8400 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8401
8402 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8403 work with a JTAG debugger.
8404 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8405 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8406 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8407 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8408 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8409 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8410 @end quotation
8411
8412 @end deffn
8413
8414 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8415 Resume the target at its current code position,
8416 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8417 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8418 @end deffn
8419
8420 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8421 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8422 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8423 @end deffn
8424
8425 @anchor{resetcommand}
8426 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8427 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8428 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8429 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8430 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8431 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8432 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8433
8434 The optional parameter specifies what should
8435 happen after the reset.
8436 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8437 The other options will not work on all systems.
8438 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8439
8440 @itemize @minus
8441 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8442 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8443 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8444 @end itemize
8445 @end deffn
8446
8447 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8448 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8449 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8450 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8451 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8452 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8453 state.
8454 @end deffn
8455
8456 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8457 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8458 Set values of reset signals.
8459 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8460 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8461 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8462 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8463
8464 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8465 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8466 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8467 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8468 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8469 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8470 the signal will not be modified.
8471
8472 @quotation Note
8473 TRST is specially handled.
8474 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8475 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8476 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8477 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8478 instead of the TRST signal.
8479 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8480 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8481 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8482 with handlers for that event.
8483 @end quotation
8484 @end deffn
8485
8486 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8487 @section Memory access commands
8488 @cindex memory access
8489
8490 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8491 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8492 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8493 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8494
8495 @enumerate
8496 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8497 to change the current target.
8498 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8499 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8500 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8501 @end enumerate
8502
8503 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8504 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8505 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8506 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8507 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8508 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8509 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8510 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8511 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8512 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8513 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8514 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8515 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8516 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8517 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8518 @end deffn
8519
8520 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8521 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8522 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8523 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8524 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8525 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8526 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8527 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8528 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8529 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8530 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8531 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8532 @end deffn
8533
8534 @anchor{imageaccess}
8535 @section Image loading commands
8536 @cindex image loading
8537 @cindex image dumping
8538
8539 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8540 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8541 binary file named @var{filename}.
8542 @end deffn
8543
8544 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8545 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8546 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8547 @end deffn
8548
8549 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8550 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8551 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8552 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8553 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8554 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8555 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8556 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8557 separately.
8558 @end deffn
8559
8560 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8561 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8562 The file format may optionally be specified
8563 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8564 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8565 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8566 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8567 @example
8568 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8569 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8570 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8571 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8572 $address $length
8573 @}
8574 @end example
8575 @end deffn
8576
8577 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8578 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8579 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8580 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8581 The file format may optionally be specified
8582 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8586 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8587 The file format may optionally be specified
8588 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8589 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8590 @end deffn
8591
8592 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8593 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8594 The file format may optionally be specified
8595 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8596 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8597 @end deffn
8598
8599
8600 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8601 @cindex breakpoint
8602 @cindex watchpoint
8603
8604 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8605 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8606 watchpoints.
8607 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8608
8609 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8610 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8611 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8612 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8613 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8614 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8615
8616 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8617 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8618 @end deffn
8619
8620 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8621 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8622 @end deffn
8623
8624 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8625 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8626 @end deffn
8627
8628 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8629 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8630 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8631 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8632 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8633 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8634 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8635 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8636 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8637 @end deffn
8638
8639
8640 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8641
8642 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8643 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8644 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8645 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8646 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8647 running, can be used.
8648 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8649 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8650 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8651
8652 @quotation Note
8653 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8654 @end quotation
8655
8656 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8657 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8658 communication, respectively.
8659
8660 @quotation Note
8661 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8662 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8663 example.
8664 @end quotation
8665
8666 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8667 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8668 of TCP/IP connections.
8669
8670 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8671 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8672 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8673 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8674 @var{size} bytes.
8675 @end deffn
8676
8677 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8678 Start RTT.
8679 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8680 @end deffn
8681
8682 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8683 Stop RTT.
8684 @end deffn
8685
8686 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8687 Display the polling interval.
8688 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8689 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8690 checked for new data.
8691 @end deffn
8692
8693 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8694 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8695 @end deffn
8696
8697 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8698 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8699 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8700 @end deffn
8701
8702 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8703 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8704 @end deffn
8705
8706 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8707 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8708 @end deffn
8709
8710 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8711 on the target device.
8712
8713 @example
8714 resume
8715
8716 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8717 rtt start
8718
8719 rtt server start 9090 0
8720 @end example
8721
8722 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8723 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8724 TCP/IP port 9090.
8725
8726
8727 @section Misc Commands
8728
8729 @cindex profiling
8730 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8731 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8732 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8733 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8734 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8735 limit the address range.
8736 @end deffn
8737
8738 @deffn {Command} {version}
8739 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8740 @end deffn
8741
8742 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8743 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8744 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8745 @end deffn
8746
8747 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8748 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8749 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8750 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8751
8752 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8753 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8754 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8755 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8756
8757 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8758 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8759 @cindex tracing
8760 @cindex ETM
8761 @cindex ETB
8762
8763 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8764 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8765 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8766
8767 @itemize
8768 @item
8769 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8770 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8771 supports such an interface.
8772 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8773 and trace port support.)
8774 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8775 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8776 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8777 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8778 in the board-specific configuration file.
8779 @item
8780 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8781 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8782 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8783 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8784 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8785 @end itemize
8786
8787 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8788
8789 @quotation Issues
8790 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8791 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8792
8793 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8794 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8795 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8796 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8797 dummy trace port driver}.
8798
8799 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8800 as well as tracing only during specific states
8801 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8802
8803 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8804 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8805 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8806 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8807 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8808
8809 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8810 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8811 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8812 this original style of JTAG access.
8813 @end quotation
8814
8815 @subsection ETM Configuration
8816 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8817
8818 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8819 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8820 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8821
8822 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8823 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8824 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8825 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8826 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8827 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8828 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8829 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8830 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8831
8832 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8833 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8834 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8835
8836 @quotation Warning
8837 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8838 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8839 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8840 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8841 @end quotation
8842
8843 @quotation Note
8844 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8845 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8846 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8847 what CPU activities are traced.
8848 @end quotation
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8852 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8853 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8854 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8855 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8856 @end deffn
8857
8858 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8859 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8860 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8861 Did trace data overflow?
8862 Was it triggered?
8863 @end deffn
8864
8865 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8866 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8867 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8868 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8869 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8870
8871 @itemize
8872 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8873 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8874 The value is one of
8875 @option{none} (save nothing),
8876 @option{data} (save data),
8877 @option{address} (save addresses),
8878 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8879 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8880 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8881 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8882 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8883 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8884 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8885 trace stream without an image of the code.
8886 @end itemize
8887 @end deffn
8888
8889 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8890 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8891 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8892 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8893 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8894
8895 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8896 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8897 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8898 @end deffn
8899
8900 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8901
8902 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8903 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8904 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8905
8906 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8907 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8908 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8909 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8910 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8911 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8912 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8913
8914 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8915
8916 @itemize
8917 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8918 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8919 for instruction access within that function's body.
8920 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8921 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8922 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8923 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8924 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8925 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8926 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8927 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8928 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8929 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8930 @item @emph{... more}
8931 @end itemize
8932
8933 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8934 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8935
8936 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8937 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8938 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8939 @end deffn
8940
8941 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8942 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8943 @end deffn
8944
8945 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8946 Opens an image file.
8947 @end deffn
8948
8949 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8950 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8951 @end deffn
8952
8953 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8954 Starts trace data collection.
8955 @end deffn
8956
8957 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8958 Stops trace data collection.
8959 @end deffn
8960
8961 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8962 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8963
8964 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8965
8966 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8967 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8968 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8969 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8970 any trace data collection.}
8971 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8972 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8973 @end deffn
8974 @end deffn
8975
8976 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8977 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8978 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8979 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8980 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8981 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8982 @end deffn
8983 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8984 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8985 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8986 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8987 trace trigger becomes active.
8988
8989 @itemize
8990 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8991 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8992 afterwards.
8993 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8994 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8995 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8996 what caused that event to happen.
8997 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8998 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8999 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9000 how the event caused trouble.
9001 @end itemize
9002 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9003 @end deffn
9004
9005 @end deffn
9006
9007 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9008 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9009 @cindex CTI
9010
9011 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9012 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9013 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9014 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9015 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9016 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9017
9018 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9019 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9020 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9021 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9022 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9023 including additional configuration.
9024 @end deffn
9025
9026 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9027 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9028 @end deffn
9029
9030 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9031 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9032 @end deffn
9033
9034 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9035 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9036 @end deffn
9037
9038 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9039 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9040 @end deffn
9041
9042 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9043 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9044 @end deffn
9045
9046 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9047 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9048 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9049 @end deffn
9050
9051 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9052 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9053 of the CTI.
9054 @end deffn
9055
9056 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9057 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9058 useful in TCL scripting.
9059 @end deffn
9060
9061 @section Generic ARM
9062 @cindex ARM
9063
9064 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9065 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9066 commands that may be available.
9067
9068 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9069 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9070 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9071 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9072 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9073 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9074 @end deffn
9075
9076 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9077 @cindex disassemble
9078 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9079 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9080 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9081 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9082 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9083 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9084 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9085
9086 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9087 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9088 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9089 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9090 with a handful of exceptions.
9091 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9092 @end deffn
9093
9094 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9095 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9096 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9097 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9098 and using the MCR instruction.
9099 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9100 an ARM register.)
9101 @end deffn
9102
9103 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9104 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9105 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9106 and the MRC instruction.
9107 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9108 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9109 an ARM register.)
9110 @end deffn
9111
9112 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9113 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9114 core mode if necessary.
9115 @end deffn
9116
9117 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9118 @cindex ARM semihosting
9119 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9120
9121 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9122 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9123 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9124 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9125 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9126 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9127 @end deffn
9128
9129 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9130 @cindex ARM semihosting
9131 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9132
9133 @example
9134 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9135 @end example
9136
9137 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9138 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9139 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9140 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9141 @end deffn
9142
9143 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9144 @cindex ARM semihosting
9145 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9146 status.
9147
9148 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9149 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9150 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9151 debugger.
9152 @end deffn
9153
9154 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9155 @cindex ARM semihosting
9156 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9157
9158 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9159 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9160 the value returned by the target.
9161
9162 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9163 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9164 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9165 encountering a break.
9166
9167 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9168 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9169 to the debugger.
9170 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9171 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9172 request or equivalent").
9173
9174 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9175 this option (default: disabled).
9176 @end deffn
9177
9178 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9179 @cindex ARMv4
9180 @cindex ARMv5
9181
9182 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9183 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9184 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9185 variant.
9186
9187 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9188 @cindex ARM7
9189 @cindex ARM9
9190
9191 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9192 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9193 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9194 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9195
9196 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9197 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9198 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9199 instead of breakpoints.
9200 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9201
9202 This should be
9203 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9204 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9205 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9206 @end deffn
9207
9208 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9209 @cindex DCC
9210 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9211 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9212 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9213
9214 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9215 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9216 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9217 @end deffn
9218
9219 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9220 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9221 that don't check completion of the operation.
9222 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9223
9224 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9225 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9226 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9227 @end deffn
9228
9229 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9230 @cindex ARM9
9231
9232 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9233 integer processors.
9234 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9235
9236 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9237 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9238 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9239 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9240
9241 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9242 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9243 @cindex vector_catch
9244 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9245 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9246 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9247 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9248 to those hardware vectors.
9249
9250 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9251 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9252 vector catch hardware to intercept
9253 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9254 @option{none} of them,
9255 or a list with one or more of the following:
9256 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9257 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9258 @end deffn
9259
9260 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9261 @cindex ARM920T
9262
9263 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9264 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9265 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9266 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9267 and ARM9 commands.
9268
9269 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9270 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9271 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9272 @end deffn
9273
9274 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9275 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9276 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9277 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9278 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9279 (Not all registers can be written.)
9280 @end deffn
9281
9282 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9283 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9284 @end deffn
9285
9286 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9287 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9291 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9292
9293 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9294 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9295 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9296 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9297 and ARM9 commands.
9298
9299 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9300 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9301
9302 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9303 Print information about the caches found.
9304 @end deffn
9305
9306 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9307 @cindex ARM966E
9308
9309 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9310 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9311 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9312 and ARM9 commands.
9313
9314 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9315 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9316 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9317 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9318 ARM966E-S TRM.
9319 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9320 as required for BIST support.
9321 @end deffn
9322
9323 @subsection XScale specific commands
9324 @cindex XScale
9325
9326 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9327
9328 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9329 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9330 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9331 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9332 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9333 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9334 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9335
9336 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9337 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9338 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9339 the mini-IC.
9340
9341 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9342 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9343 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9344 code layout in memory:
9345 @example
9346 _vectors:
9347 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9348 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9349 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9350 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9351 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9352 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9353 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9354 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9355 .org 0x100
9356 .long real_reset_vector
9357 .long real_ui_handler
9358 .long real_swi_handler
9359 .long real_pf_abort
9360 .long real_data_abort
9361 .long 0 /* unused */
9362 .long real_irq_handler
9363 .long real_fiq_handler
9364 @end example
9365
9366 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9367 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9368 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9369 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9370 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9371 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9372 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9373 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9374 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9375 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9376 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9377 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9378 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9379 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9380 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9381 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9382 software.
9383
9384 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9385 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9386 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9387 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9388
9389 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9390 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9391 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9392 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9393 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9394 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9395 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9396 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9397 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9398
9399 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9400 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9401
9402 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9403 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9404 @end deffn
9405
9406 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9407 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9411 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9412 @end deffn
9413
9414 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9415 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9416 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9420 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9421 @end deffn
9422
9423 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9424 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9425 @end deffn
9426
9427 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9428 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9429 @end deffn
9430
9431 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9432 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9433 @end deffn
9434
9435 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9436 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9437 @end deffn
9438
9439 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9440 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9441 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9442 and modifying how it is emptied.
9443 @end deffn
9444
9445 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9446 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9447 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9448 The image @var{type} may be one of
9449 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9450 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9451 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9452 @end deffn
9453
9454 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9455 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9456 @cindex vector_catch
9457 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9458 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9459
9460 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9461 @example
9462 0x01 Trap Reset
9463 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9464 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9465 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9466 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9467 0x20 reserved
9468 0x40 Trap IRQ
9469 0x80 Trap FIQ
9470 @end example
9471 @end deffn
9472
9473 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9474 @cindex vector_table
9475
9476 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9477 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9478 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9479 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9480 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9481
9482 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9483
9484 @end deffn
9485
9486 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9487 @cindex ARMv6
9488
9489 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9490 @cindex ARM11
9491
9492 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9493 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9494 which is enabled by default.
9495 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9496 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9497 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9498 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9499 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9500 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9501 @end deffn
9502
9503 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9504 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9505 which is enabled by default.
9506 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9507 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9508 @end deffn
9509
9510 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9511 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9512 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9513 they are disabled by default.
9514 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9515 @end deffn
9516
9517 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9518 @cindex vector_catch
9519 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9520 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9521 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9522
9523 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9524 for certain hardware events.
9525 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9526 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9527 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9528 @end deffn
9529
9530 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9531 @cindex ARMv7
9532 @cindex ARMv8
9533
9534 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9535 @cindex Cortex-A
9536
9537 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9538 display information about target caches
9539 @end deffn
9540
9541 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9542 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9543 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9544 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9545 Defaults to 'off'.
9546 @end deffn
9547
9548 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9549 Initialize core debug
9550 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9551 @end deffn
9552
9553 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9554 Display/set the current SMP mode
9555 @end deffn
9556
9557 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9558 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9559 @end deffn
9560
9561 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9562 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9563 @end deffn
9564
9565 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9566 configure l2x cache
9567 @end deffn
9568
9569 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9570 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9571 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9572 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9573 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9574 @end deffn
9575
9576 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9577 @cindex Cortex-R
9578
9579 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r dbginit}
9580 Initialize core debug
9581 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9582 @end deffn
9583
9584 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9585 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9586 @end deffn
9587
9588
9589 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9590 @cindex tracing
9591 @cindex SWO
9592 @cindex SWV
9593 @cindex TPIU
9594
9595 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9596 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9597 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9598 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9599
9600 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9601 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9602 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9603 which causes quite some confusion.
9604 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9605 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9606
9607 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9608 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9609 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9610
9611 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9612 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9613 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9614 @end deffn
9615
9616 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9617 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9618 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9619 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9620
9621 @itemize @bullet
9622 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9623 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9624 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9625 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9626
9627 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9628 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9629 @end itemize
9630 @end deffn
9631
9632 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9633 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9634 @end deffn
9635
9636 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9637 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9638 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9639 at any time after the initialization, too.
9640 @end deffn
9641
9642 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9643 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9644 individually queried, to return its current value.
9645 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9646 @end deffn
9647
9648 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9649 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9650 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9651 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9652
9653 @itemize @bullet
9654 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9655 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9656
9657 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9658 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9659
9660 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9661 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9662
9663 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9664 protocol used for trace data:
9665 @itemize @minus
9666 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9667 data bits (default);
9668 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9669 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9670 @end itemize
9671
9672 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9673 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9674 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9675 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9676 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9677 of the TPIU.
9678
9679 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9680 the destination of the trace data:
9681 @itemize @minus
9682 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9683 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9684 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9685 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9686 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9687 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9688 each connected client;
9689 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9690 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9691 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9692 @end itemize
9693
9694 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9695 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9696 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9697 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9698
9699 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9700 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9701 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9702 maximum supported rate automatically.
9703
9704 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9705 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9706 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9707
9708 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9709 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9710 default value is @var{0}.
9711 @end itemize
9712 @end deffn
9713
9714 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9715 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9716 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9717 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9718 data.
9719 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9720 after the @command{init}.
9721 @end deffn
9722
9723 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9724 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9725 @end deffn
9726
9727
9728
9729 Example usage:
9730 @enumerate
9731 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9732 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9733 enough to:
9734 @example
9735 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9736 ...
9737 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9738 ...
9739 @end example
9740 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9741 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9742 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9743 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9744 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9745 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9746 @example
9747 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9748 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9749 @end example
9750 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9751 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9752 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9753 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9754 @example
9755 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9756 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9757 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9758 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9759 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9760 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9761 @end example
9762 @end enumerate
9763
9764 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9765 @cindex tracing
9766 @cindex SWO
9767 @cindex SWV
9768 @cindex ITM
9769 @cindex ETM
9770
9771 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9772 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9773 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9774 @end deffn
9775
9776 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9777 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9778 @end deffn
9779
9780 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9781 @cindex Cortex-M
9782
9783 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9784 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9785
9786 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9787 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9788 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9789 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9790 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9791 the step command leaves with the core running.
9792
9793 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9794 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9795 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9796 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9797
9798 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9799 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9800 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9801 does.
9802
9803 Default is @option{auto}.
9804 @end deffn
9805
9806 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9807 @cindex vector_catch
9808 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9809 for certain hardware events.
9810
9811 Parameters request interception of
9812 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9813 @option{none} of them,
9814 or one or more of the following:
9815 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9816 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9817 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9818 @option{irq_err},
9819 @option{state_err},
9820 @option{chk_err}, or
9821 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9822 @option{reset}.
9823 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9824 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9825 are mapped to HardFault.
9826 UsageFault checks for
9827 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9828 must also be explicitly enabled.
9829
9830 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9831 @end deffn
9832
9833 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9834 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9835 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9836
9837 @itemize @minus
9838 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9839 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9840 @end itemize
9841
9842 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9843 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9844 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9845 to manually reset the peripherals.
9846 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9847
9848 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9849 instead.
9850 @end deffn
9851
9852 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9853 @cindex ARMv8-A
9854 @cindex aarch64
9855
9856 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9857 Display information about target caches
9858 @end deffn
9859
9860 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9861 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9862 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9863 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9864 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9865 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9866 @end deffn
9867
9868 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9869 @cindex disassemble
9870 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9871 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9872 @end deffn
9873
9874 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9875 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9876 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9877 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9878 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9879 @end deffn
9880
9881 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9882 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9883 @option{on}.
9884 @end deffn
9885
9886 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9887 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9888 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9889 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9890 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9891 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9892 @end deffn
9893
9894 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9895
9896 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9897 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9898
9899 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9900
9901 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9902 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9903 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9904 @end deffn
9905
9906 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9907 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9908 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9909 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9910 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9911 @end deffn
9912
9913 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9914
9915 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9916 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9917 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9918 @end deffn
9919
9920 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9921
9922 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9923 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9924 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9925 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9926 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9927 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9928 can be collected.
9929
9930 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9931 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9932 tooling.
9933
9934 @quotation Issues
9935 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9936 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9937 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9938 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9939
9940 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9941 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9942 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9943 software operation on the CPU.
9944 @end quotation
9945
9946 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9947 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9948 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9949 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9950 @end deffn
9951
9952 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9953 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9954 @end deffn
9955
9956 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9957 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9958 control is disabled.
9959 @end deffn
9960
9961 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9962 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9963 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9964 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9965
9966 Supported trace formats:
9967 @itemize
9968 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9969 timing to be determined.
9970 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9971 addresses.
9972 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9973 @end itemize
9974 @end deffn
9975
9976 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9977 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9978 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9979 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9980
9981 Supported conditions:
9982 @itemize
9983 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9984 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9985 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9986 instruction matches start data and mask.
9987 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9988 instruction matches start data and mask.
9989 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9990 data and mask.
9991 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9992 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9993 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9994 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9995 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9996 @end itemize
9997 @end deffn
9998
9999 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10000 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10001 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10002 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10003
10004 Supported conditions:
10005 @itemize
10006 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10007 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10008 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10009 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10010 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10011 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10012 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10013 data and mask.
10014 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10015 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10016 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10017 @end itemize
10018 @end deffn
10019
10020 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10021 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10022
10023 Supported triggers:
10024 @itemize
10025 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10026 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10027 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10028 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10029 collection.
10030 @end itemize
10031 @end deffn
10032
10033 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10034
10035 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10036 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10037 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10038 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10039 @end deffn
10040
10041 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10042 Display trace configuration.
10043 @end deffn
10044
10045 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10046 Display trace collection status.
10047 @end deffn
10048
10049 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10050 Start manual trace collection.
10051 @end deffn
10052
10053 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10054 Stop manual trace collection.
10055 @end deffn
10056
10057 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10058 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10059 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10060 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10061 @option{size} options using DMA.
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10065 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10066 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10067 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10068 @option{size} options using DMA.
10069 @end deffn
10070
10071 @section Intel Architecture
10072
10073 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10074 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10075 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10076 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10077 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10078 @itemize
10079 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10080 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10081 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10082 @end itemize
10083
10084 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10085 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10086 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10087
10088 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10089 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10090 @end deffn
10091
10092 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10093 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10094 @end deffn
10095
10096 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10097 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10098 @end deffn
10099
10100 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10101 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10102 @end deffn
10103
10104 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10105 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10106 @end deffn
10107
10108 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10109 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10110 @end deffn
10111
10112 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10113
10114 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10115 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10116
10117 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10118 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10119 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10120 @end deffn
10121 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10122 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10123
10124 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10125
10126 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10127 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10128 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10129 @end deffn
10130
10131 @subsection Registers commands
10132 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10133 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10134 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10135
10136 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10137
10138 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10139 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10140 and "timer" groups.
10141
10142 @emph{example:}
10143 @example
10144 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10145 @end example
10146
10147
10148 @end deffn
10149 @deffn {Command} {readgroup} (@option{group})
10150 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
10151
10152 @emph{group} can be "system",
10153 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
10154 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
10155 @end deffn
10156
10157 @section RISC-V Architecture
10158
10159 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10160 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10161 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10162 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10163 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10164 implement version 0.11.
10165
10166 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10167
10168 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10169 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10170 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10171
10172 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10173
10174 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10175 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10176 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10177
10178 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10179 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10180 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10181 CSRs.
10182 @end deffn
10183
10184 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10185 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10186 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10187 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10188 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10189 This command must be executed before `init`.
10190 @end deffn
10191
10192 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10193 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10194 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10195 @end deffn
10196
10197 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10198 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10199 deasserted.
10200 @end deffn
10201
10202 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10203 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10204 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10205 @end deffn
10206
10207 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10208 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10209 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10210 on physical memory.
10211 @end deffn
10212
10213 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10214 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10215 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10216 performed on physical memory.
10217 @end deffn
10218
10219 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10220 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10221 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10222 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10223 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10224 race condition problem in your code.
10225
10226 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10227 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10228 @end deffn
10229
10230 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10231 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10232 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10233 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10234 values.
10235
10236 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10237 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10238 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10239 @end deffn
10240
10241 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10242 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10243 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10244 @end deffn
10245
10246 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10247 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10248 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10249 @end deffn
10250
10251 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10252 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10253 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10254 @end deffn
10255
10256 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10257 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10258 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10259 @end deffn
10260
10261 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10262
10263 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10264 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10265 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10266 @example
10267 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10268 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10269 @end example
10270
10271 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10272 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10273 @end deffn
10274
10275 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10276 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10277 @end deffn
10278
10279 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10280
10281 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10282 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10283
10284 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10285 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10286 @end deffn
10287
10288 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10289 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10290 @end deffn
10291
10292 @section ARC Architecture
10293 @cindex ARC
10294
10295 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10296 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10297 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10298 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10299 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10300 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10301 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10302 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10303 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10304 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10305 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10306 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10307 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10308 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10309 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10310
10311
10312 @subsection General ARC commands
10313
10314 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10315
10316 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10317 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10318 arguments:
10319
10320 @itemize @bullet
10321
10322 @item @code{-name} name
10323 @*Name of a register.
10324
10325 @item @code{-num} number
10326 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10327
10328 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10329 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10330
10331 @end itemize
10332
10333 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10334
10335 @itemize @bullet
10336
10337 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10338 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10339 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10340 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10341 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10342 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10343
10344 @item @code{-core}
10345 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10346 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10347 spaces.
10348
10349 @item @code{-bcr}
10350 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10351 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10352 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10353 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10354 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10355
10356 @item @code{-type} type_name
10357 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10358 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10359
10360 @item @code{-g}
10361 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10362 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10363 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10364 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10365 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10366
10367 @end itemize
10368
10369 @end deffn
10370
10371 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10372 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10373 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10374 @end deffn
10375
10376 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10377 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10378 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10379 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10380 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10381 startbit endbit}.
10382 @end deffn
10383
10384 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10385 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10386 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10387 @end deffn
10388
10389 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10390 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10391 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10392 @end deffn
10393
10394 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10395
10396 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10397 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10398 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10399 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10400
10401 @end deffn
10402
10403 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10404 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10405 registers.
10406 @end deffn
10407
10408 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10409 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10410 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10411 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10412
10413 @end deffn
10414
10415 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10416 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10417 registers.
10418 @end deffn
10419
10420 @section STM8 Architecture
10421 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10422 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10423
10424 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10425 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10426
10427 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10428 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10429 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10430 @cindex tracing
10431 @cindex libdcc
10432 @cindex DCC
10433 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10434 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10435 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10436 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10437
10438 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10439 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10440 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10441 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10442 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10443 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10444
10445 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10446 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10447 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10448 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10449 The target being debugged may
10450 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10451 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10452 each supported by a command:
10453
10454 @itemize
10455 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10456 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10457 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10458 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10459
10460 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10461 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10462 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10463
10464 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10465 and then displayed at any time.
10466 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10467
10468 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10469 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10470 @end itemize
10471
10472 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10473 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10474 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10475 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10476 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10477 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10478 does the same thing.
10479
10480 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10481 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10482 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10483 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10484 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10485
10486 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10487 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10488 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10489 @end deffn
10490
10491 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10492 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10493 in the order they triggered.
10494 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10495 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10496 history records.
10497 @end deffn
10498
10499 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10500 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10501 they have been triggered.
10502 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10503 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10504 and associates it with that identifier.
10505
10506 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10507 are not related except by this command.
10508 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10509 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10510 @end deffn
10511
10512
10513 @node JTAG Commands
10514 @chapter JTAG Commands
10515 @cindex JTAG Commands
10516 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10517 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10518 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10519 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10520 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10521
10522 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10523 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10524
10525 @itemize @bullet
10526 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10527 devices such as a CPUs.
10528 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10529 standard state machine (in parallel)
10530 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10531 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10532 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10533 while the reading previous ones.
10534 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10535 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10536 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10537 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10538 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10539 registers.
10540 @end itemize
10541
10542 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10543
10544 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10545 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10546 the order of TAP state transitions.
10547 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10548 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10549 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10550 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10551 these commands are not available.
10552
10553 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10554 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10555 that specify the entire register.
10556 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10557 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10558 The return value holds the original value of each
10559 of those fields.
10560
10561 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10562 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10563 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10564 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10565 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10566
10567 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10568 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10569
10570 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10571 in that state.
10572 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10573 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10574 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10575
10576 @quotation Warning
10577 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10578 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10579 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10580 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10581 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10582 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10583 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10584 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10585 @end quotation
10586 @end deffn
10587
10588 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10589 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10590 This may be used for performance tuning.
10591
10592 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10593 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10594 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10595 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10596 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10597 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10598 @end deffn
10599
10600 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10601 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10602 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10603 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10604 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10605 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10606
10607 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10608 in that state.
10609 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10610 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10611 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10612
10613 @quotation Note
10614 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10615 register values, unlike data register values.
10616 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10617 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10618 @end quotation
10619 @end deffn
10620
10621 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10622 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10623 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10624 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10625 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10626 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10627 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10628 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10629 The final state must also be stable.
10630 @end deffn
10631
10632 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10633 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10634 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10635 Instructions often need some time
10636 to execute before they take effect.
10637 @end deffn
10638
10639 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10640 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10641
10642 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10643 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10644 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10645 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10646 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10647 @end deffn
10648
10649 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10650 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10651 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10652 must also be enabled.
10653 Default is enabled.
10654 @end deffn
10655
10656 @section TAP state names
10657 @cindex TAP state names
10658
10659 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10660 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10661 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10662 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10663
10664 @itemize @bullet
10665 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10666 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10667 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10668 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10669 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10670 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10671 through the data register
10672 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10673 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10674 for update or more shifting
10675 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10676 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10677 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10678 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10679 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10680 through the instruction register
10681 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10682 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10683 for update or more shifting
10684 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10685 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10686 @end itemize
10687
10688 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10689 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10690 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10691 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10692
10693 @itemize @bullet
10694 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10695 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10696 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10697 may not be as expected.
10698 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10699 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10700 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10701 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10702 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10703 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10704 @end itemize
10705
10706 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10707 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10708
10709 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10710 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10711 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10712 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10713
10714 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10715 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10716 @cindex SVF
10717
10718 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10719 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10720 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10721 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10722
10723 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10724 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10725 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10726 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10727
10728 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10729 affect their semantics.
10730
10731 Command options:
10732 @itemize @minus
10733 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10734 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10735 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10736 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10737 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10738 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10739 on the real interface;
10740 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10741 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10742 errors.
10743 @end itemize
10744 @end deffn
10745
10746 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10747 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10748 @cindex XSVF
10749
10750 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10751 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10752 Xilinx devices.
10753 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10754 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10755
10756 @quotation Important
10757 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10758 @end quotation
10759
10760 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10761 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10762 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10763 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10764 that TAP.
10765 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10766 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10767 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10768 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10769 @end deffn
10770
10771 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10772 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10773 after building the software.
10774 You may find them useful:
10775
10776 @itemize
10777 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10778 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10779 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10780 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10781 @end itemize
10782
10783 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10784 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10785 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10786 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10787 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10788 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10789 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10790
10791
10792 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10793 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10794 @cindex IPDBG
10795
10796 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10797 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10798 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10799 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10800 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10801 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10802
10803 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10804 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10805
10806 Command options:
10807 @itemize @bullet
10808 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10809 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10810 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10811 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10812 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10813 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10814 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10815 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10816 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10817 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10818 shift data through vir can be configured.
10819 @end itemize
10820 @end deffn
10821
10822 Examples:
10823 @example
10824 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10825 @end example
10826 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10827 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10828
10829 @example
10830 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10831 @end example
10832 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10833 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10834
10835 @node Utility Commands
10836 @chapter Utility Commands
10837 @cindex Utility Commands
10838
10839 @section RAM testing
10840 @cindex RAM testing
10841
10842 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10843 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10844 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10845 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10846 hardware problems.
10847
10848 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10849 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10850 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10851 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10852
10853 Load the memory testing functions with
10854
10855 @example
10856 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10857 @end example
10858
10859 to get access to the following facilities:
10860
10861 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10862 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10863 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10864 @end deffn
10865
10866 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10867 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10868 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10869 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10870 @end deffn
10871
10872 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10873 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10874 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10875 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10876 @end deffn
10877
10878 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10879 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10880 @end deffn
10881
10882 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10883 @cindex Firmware recovery
10884
10885 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10886 devices recovery with JTAG.
10887
10888 For quickstart instructions run:
10889 @example
10890 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10891 @end example
10892
10893 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10894 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10895 @cindex GDB
10896 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10897 to debug remote targets.
10898 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10899
10900 @itemize
10901 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10902 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10903 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10904 as shown in this chapter.
10905 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10906 that also will probably need to be configured.
10907 @end itemize
10908
10909 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10910 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10911 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10912 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10913 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10914 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10915
10916 @section Connecting to GDB
10917 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10918 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10919 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10920 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10921 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10922
10923 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10924
10925 @enumerate
10926 @item
10927 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10928 @example
10929 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10930 @end example
10931 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10932
10933 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10934 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10935 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10936
10937 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10938 remote command above that becomes:
10939 @example
10940 tar ext :3333
10941 @end example
10942
10943 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10944 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10945 available through the command:
10946 @example
10947 target remote localhost:3333
10948 @end example
10949
10950 @item
10951 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10952 @example
10953 target extended-remote | \
10954 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10955 @end example
10956 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10957 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10958 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10959 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10960 @end enumerate
10961
10962 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10963 GDB command line.
10964
10965 @section Sample GDB session startup
10966
10967 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10968 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10969 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10970 small ARM program.
10971 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10972 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10973
10974 @example
10975 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10976 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10977 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10978 ...
10979 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10980 ...
10981 (gdb) load
10982 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10983 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10984 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10985 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10986 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10987 (gdb) continue
10988 Continuing.
10989 ...
10990 @end example
10991
10992 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10993 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10994 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10995 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10996
10997 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10998
10999 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11000 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11001 packet size and the device's memory map.
11002 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11003 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11004 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11005
11006 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11007 You may need to set those up by hand.
11008 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11009 something like:
11010
11011 @example
11012 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11013 @end example
11014
11015 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11016
11017 @example
11018 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11019 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11020 @end example
11021
11022 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11023 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11024 do not have such restrictions.
11025
11026 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11027 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11028 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11029 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11030
11031 @section Programming using GDB
11032 @cindex Programming using GDB
11033 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11034
11035 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11036 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11037 @example
11038 gdb_memory_map disable
11039 @end example
11040 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11041 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11042 working area.
11043
11044 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11045 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11046 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11047 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11048
11049 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11050 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11051
11052 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11053 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11054 @example
11055 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11056 @end example
11057
11058 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11059 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11060
11061 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11062 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11063 will be used.
11064
11065 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11066 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11067 @example
11068 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11069 @end example
11070 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11071
11072 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11073 can be used.
11074
11075 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11076 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11077 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11078
11079 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11080 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11081 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11082
11083 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11084 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11085 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11086 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11087 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11088 without any intrusion of the target process.
11089
11090 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11091 Place following command after target configuration:
11092 @example
11093 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11094 @end example
11095
11096 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11097 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11098 @example
11099 gdb_memory_map disable
11100 @end example
11101
11102 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11103 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11104 @example
11105 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11106 @end example
11107
11108 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11109 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11110
11111 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11112 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11113 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11114 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11115
11116 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11117 previously shown variables.
11118
11119 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11120 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11121 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11122 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11123 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11124
11125 @section RTOS Support
11126 @cindex RTOS Support
11127 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11128
11129 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11130 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11131
11132 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11133 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11134 GDB commands.
11135
11136 @* An example setup is below:
11137
11138 @example
11139 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11140 @end example
11141
11142 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11143
11144 Currently supported rtos's include:
11145 @itemize @bullet
11146 @item @option{eCos}
11147 @item @option{ThreadX}
11148 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11149 @item @option{linux}
11150 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11151 @item @option{embKernel}
11152 @item @option{mqx}
11153 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11154 @item @option{nuttx}
11155 @item @option{RIOT}
11156 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11157 @item @option{Zephyr}
11158 @end itemize
11159
11160 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11161 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11162
11163 @table @code
11164 @item eCos symbols
11165 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11166 @item ThreadX symbols
11167 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11168 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11169 @raggedright
11170 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11171 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11172 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11173 @end raggedright
11174 @item linux symbols
11175 init_task.
11176 @item ChibiOS symbols
11177 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11178 @item embKernel symbols
11179 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11180 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11181 @item mqx symbols
11182 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11183 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11184 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11185 @item nuttx symbols
11186 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11187 @item RIOT symbols
11188 @raggedright
11189 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11190 _tcb_name_offset.
11191 @end raggedright
11192 @item Zephyr symbols
11193 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11194 @end table
11195
11196 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11197 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11198
11199 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11200 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11201
11202 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11203 along with the project:
11204
11205 @table @code
11206 @item FreeRTOS
11207 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11208 @item uC/OS-III
11209 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11210 @end table
11211
11212 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11213 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11214 @cindex SMP
11215 @cindex RTOS
11216 @cindex hwthread
11217 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11218 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11219 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11220 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11221 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11222 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11223 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11224 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11225 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11226
11227 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11228 @quotation Note
11229 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11230 @end quotation
11231
11232 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11233 @itemize @bullet
11234 @item j - smp status request
11235 @item J - smp set request
11236 @end itemize
11237
11238 OpenOCD implements :
11239 @itemize @bullet
11240 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11241 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11242 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11243 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11244 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11245 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11246 @end itemize
11247
11248 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11249 @itemize @bullet
11250 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11251 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11252 @example
11253 set $_core 1
11254 #Jc01 packet is sent
11255 print $_core
11256 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11257 @end example
11258
11259 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11260 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11261
11262 @example
11263 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11264 define toggle0
11265 maint packet Jc0
11266 continue
11267 main packet Jc-1
11268 end
11269 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11270 define toggle1
11271 maint packet Jc1
11272 continue
11273 main packet Jc-1
11274 end
11275 @end example
11276 @end itemize
11277
11278 @node Tcl Scripting API
11279 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11280 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11281 @cindex Tcl scripts
11282 @section API rules
11283
11284 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11285 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11286 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11287
11288 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11289 pair list and lists.
11290
11291 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11292 list.
11293
11294 @example
11295 > set foo(me) Duane
11296 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11297 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11298 > set foo(duck) Donald
11299 @end example
11300
11301 If one does this:
11302
11303 @example
11304 > set foo
11305 @end example
11306
11307 The result is:
11308
11309 @example
11310 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11311 @end example
11312
11313 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11314
11315 @verbatim
11316 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11317 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11318 }
11319 @end verbatim
11320
11321 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11322 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11323
11324 @section Internal low-level Commands
11325
11326 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11327 invoke directly.
11328
11329 @itemize @bullet
11330 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11331
11332 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11333 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11334
11335 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11336 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11337
11338 Return information about the flash banks
11339
11340 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11341
11342 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11343 its execution. Example:
11344
11345 @example
11346 > capture "reset init"
11347 @end example
11348
11349 @end itemize
11350
11351 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11352 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11353 called "flash_banks".
11354
11355 @section Tcl RPC server
11356 @cindex RPC
11357
11358 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11359 commands and receive the results.
11360
11361 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11362 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11363 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11364 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11365 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11366
11367 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11368 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11369 @command{capture} command.
11370
11371 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11372
11373 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11374 @cindex RPC Notifications
11375
11376 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11377 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11378
11379 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11380 in the following format.
11381
11382 @verbatim
11383 type target_event event [event-name]
11384 type target_state state [state-name]
11385 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11386 @end verbatim
11387
11388 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11389 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11390 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11391 Defaults to off.
11392
11393 @end deffn
11394
11395 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11396 @cindex RPC trace output
11397
11398 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11399 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11400
11401 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11402
11403 @verbatim
11404 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11405 @end verbatim
11406
11407 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11408 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11409 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11410 Defaults to off.
11411
11412 See an example application here:
11413 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11414
11415 @end deffn
11416
11417 @node FAQ
11418 @chapter FAQ
11419 @cindex faq
11420 @enumerate
11421 @anchor{faqrtck}
11422 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11423 @cindex RTCK
11424 @cindex adaptive clocking
11425 @*
11426
11427 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11428 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11429 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11430 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11431
11432 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11433 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11434 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11435 @enumerate
11436 @item
11437 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11438 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11439 @item
11440 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11441 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11442 @end enumerate
11443
11444 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11445 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11446 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11447 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11448 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11449 power).
11450
11451 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11452 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11453 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11454 ARM926 scenario).
11455 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11456 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11457 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11458
11459 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11460 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11461 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11462 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11463
11464 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11465
11466 In order to make use of this,
11467 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11468 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11469
11470 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11471 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11472 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11473 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11474 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11475
11476 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11477 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11478 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11479 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11480
11481 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11482 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11483 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11484 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11485 with a CPLD.
11486 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11487 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11488 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11489 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11490 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11491 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11492
11493 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11494
11495 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11496
11497 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11498 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11499 depending on the chips on your board.
11500 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11501 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11502 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11503
11504 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11505 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11506 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11507
11508 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11509 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11510 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11511 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11512
11513 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11514 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11515 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11516 this way.
11517
11518 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11519 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11520 clock rate.
11521 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11522 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11523 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11524
11525 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11526
11527 @example
11528 # Example: 1.234MHz
11529 adapter speed 1234
11530 @end example
11531
11532
11533 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11534
11535 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11536 around Windows filenames.
11537
11538 @example
11539 > echo \a
11540
11541 > echo @{\a@}
11542 \a
11543 > echo "\a"
11544
11545 >
11546 @end example
11547
11548
11549 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11550
11551 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11552 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11553 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11554
11555 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11556 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11557 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11558
11559 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11560 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11561 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11562
11563 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11564
11565 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11566 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11567 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11568 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11569
11570 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11571 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11572 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11573
11574 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11575 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11576
11577 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11578 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11579 memory read caused data abort".
11580
11581 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11582 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11583 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11584 be done, feel free to add this here.
11585
11586 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11587 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11588 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11589 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11590 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11591 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11592 gracefully stops.
11593
11594 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11595 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11596 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11597
11598 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11599 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11600 bytes. Painful...
11601
11602
11603 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11604 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11605
11606 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11607 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11608 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11609 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11610 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11611 reset, everything else should work fine.
11612
11613 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11614 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11615 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11616 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11617
11618 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11619 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11620 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11621 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11622
11623 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11624
11625 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11626 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11627 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11628
11629 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11630 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11631
11632 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11633 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11634 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11635 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11636 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11637 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11638 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11639 clock frequency?
11640
11641 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11642 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11643 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11644 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11645 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11646
11647 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11648
11649 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11650 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11651 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11652 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11653 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11654 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11655 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11656
11657 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11658
11659 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11660 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11661 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11662 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11663
11664 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11665 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11666 particular order?
11667
11668 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11669 the same order used by the hardware.
11670
11671 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11672 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11673 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11674 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11675 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11676 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11677
11678 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11679 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11680 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11681 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11682
11683 @itemize @bullet
11684 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11685 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11686 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11687 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11688 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11689 @end itemize
11690
11691 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11692
11693 @itemize @bullet
11694 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11695 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11696 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11697 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11698 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11699 @end itemize
11700
11701
11702 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11703 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11704 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11705
11706 TODO.
11707
11708 @end enumerate
11709
11710 @node Tcl Crash Course
11711 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11712 @cindex Tcl
11713
11714 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11715 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11716 how the Tcl scripts work.
11717
11718 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11719 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11720 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11721 OpenOCD.
11722
11723 @section Tcl Rule #1
11724 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11725 @enumerate
11726 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11727 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11728 @end enumerate
11729
11730 The Tcl equal is this:
11731
11732 @enumerate
11733 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11734 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11735 @end enumerate
11736
11737 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11738 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11739
11740 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11741 There is a second pair of rules.
11742 @enumerate
11743 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11744 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11745 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11746 in Tcl.
11747 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11748 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11749 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11750 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11751 @end enumerate
11752
11753 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11754 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11755 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11756 Everything is a string}
11757
11758 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11759 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11760 difference is subtle.
11761 @enumerate
11762 @item Parse Time
11763 @item Evaluation Time
11764 @end enumerate
11765
11766 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11767 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11768 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11769
11770 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11771 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11772 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11773 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11774
11775 @itemize @bullet
11776 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11777 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11778 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11779 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11780 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11781 @example
11782 # bash example
11783 X=`date`
11784 echo "The Date is: $X"
11785 # Tcl example
11786 set X [date]
11787 puts "The Date is: $X"
11788 @end example
11789 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11790 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11791 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11792 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11793 is a string}
11794 @example
11795 set x "Dinner"
11796 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11797 @end example
11798 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11799 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11800 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11801 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11802 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11803 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11804 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11805 @end itemize
11806
11807 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11808
11809 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11810
11811 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11812
11813 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11814 the normal way.
11815
11816 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11817 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11818 line is immediately executed.
11819
11820 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11821 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11822
11823 @subsection Command Execution
11824
11825 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11826 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11827 control flow operators.
11828
11829 Commands are executed like this:
11830
11831 @enumerate
11832 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11833 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11834 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11835 @end enumerate
11836
11837 It sort of works like this:
11838 @example
11839 for(;;)@{
11840 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11841
11842 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11843
11844 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11845 @}
11846 @end example
11847
11848 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11849 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11850 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11851 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11852 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11853 ``LookupCommand()''
11854
11855 @subsection The FOR command
11856
11857 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11858 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11859 command just like any other command.
11860
11861 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11862 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11863 are:
11864
11865 @enumerate 0
11866 @item The ascii text 'for'
11867 @item The start text
11868 @item The test expression
11869 @item The next text
11870 @item The body text
11871 @end enumerate
11872
11873 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11874 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11875 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11876 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11877
11878 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11879 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11880
11881 @example
11882 int
11883 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11884 int *argc,
11885 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11886 @end example
11887
11888 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11889 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11890 still operates in the same basic way.
11891
11892 @subsection FOR command implementation
11893
11894 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11895 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11896
11897 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11898
11899 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11900
11901 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11902 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11903 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11904
11905 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11906 expression and returns a value.
11907
11908 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11909 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11910 @example
11911 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11912
11913 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11914
11915 int
11916 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11917 int argc,
11918 char **argv )
11919 @{
11920 if( argc != 5 )@{
11921 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11922 return ERROR;
11923 @}
11924
11925 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11926
11927 // Execute the start statement.
11928 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11929
11930 // Top of loop test
11931 for(;;)@{
11932 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11933 if( i == 0 )
11934 break;
11935
11936 // Execute the body
11937 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11938
11939 // Execute the LOOP part
11940 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11941 @}
11942
11943 // Return no error
11944 SetResult( interp, "" );
11945 return SUCCESS;
11946 @}
11947 @end example
11948
11949 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11950 in the same basic way.
11951
11952 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11953
11954 @subsection source and find commands
11955 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11956 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11957 @*Remember the parsing rules
11958 @enumerate
11959 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11960 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11961 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11962 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11963 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11964 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11965 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11966 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11967 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11968 @end enumerate
11969 @subsection format command
11970 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11971 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11972 @b{sprintf()}.
11973 @b{Example}
11974 @example
11975 set x 6
11976 set y 7
11977 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11978 @end example
11979 @enumerate
11980 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11981 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11982 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11983 @* Refer to Rule #1
11984 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11985 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11986 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11987 @end enumerate
11988 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11989 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11990 @example
11991 #1 Good
11992 proc someproc @{@} @{
11993 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11994 @}
11995 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11996 #2 Good - no variables
11997 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11998 #3 Good Curly Braces
11999 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12000 puts "Time: [date]"
12001 @}
12002 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12003 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12004 @end example
12005 @enumerate
12006 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12007 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12008 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12009 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12010 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12011 command.
12012 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12013 @*There are 4 examples:
12014 @enumerate
12015 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12016 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12017 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12018 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12019 @end enumerate
12020
12021 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12022 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12023 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12024
12025 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12026 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12027 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12028 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12029 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12030 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12031 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12032 @end enumerate
12033 @subsection Global Variables
12034 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12035 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12036 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12037 @example
12038 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12039 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12040 global x #Global variable X
12041 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12042 @}
12043 @end example
12044 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12045 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12046 @example
12047 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12048 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12049 # Create var name
12050 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12051 # Make it a global
12052 global $vn
12053 # Set it.
12054 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12055 @}
12056 @end example
12057 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12058 @example
12059 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12060 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12061 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12062 @}
12063 @end example
12064
12065 @node License
12066 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12067 @include fdl.texi
12068
12069 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12070 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12071 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12072 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12073 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12074 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12075
12076 @printindex cp
12077
12078 @node Command and Driver Index
12079 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12080 @printindex fn
12081
12082 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)